1@c Copyright (C) 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
2@c This is part of the GCC manual.
3@c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
4
5@node Target Macros
6@chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
7@cindex machine description macros
8@cindex target description macros
9@cindex macros, target description
10@cindex @file{tm.h} macros
11
12In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
13includes a C header file conventionally given the name
14@file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
15The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
16about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
17@file{.md} file.  The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
18@file{@var{machine}.h}.  The header file @file{config.h} includes
19@file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}.  The
20source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
21containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
22machine.  @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
23if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
24through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
25
26@menu
27* Target Structure::    The @code{targetm} variable.
28* Driver::              Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
29* Run-time Target::     Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
30* Per-Function Data::   Defining data structures for per-function information.
31* Storage Layout::      Defining sizes and alignments of data.
32* Type Layout::         Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
33* Registers::           Naming and describing the hardware registers.
34* Register Classes::    Defining the classes of hardware registers.
35* Stack and Calling::   Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
36* Varargs::             Defining the varargs macros.
37* Trampolines::         Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
38* Library Calls::       Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
39* Addressing Modes::    Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
40* Anchored Addresses::  Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
41* Condition Code::      Defining how insns update the condition code.
42* Costs::               Defining relative costs of different operations.
43* Scheduling::          Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
44* Sections::            Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
45* PIC::                 Macros for position independent code.
46* Assembler Format::    Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
47* Debugging Info::      Defining the format of debugging output.
48* Floating Point::      Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
49* Mode Switching::      Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
50* Target Attributes::   Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
51* Emulated TLS::        Emulated TLS support.
52* MIPS Coprocessors::   MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
53* PCH Target::          Validity checking for precompiled headers.
54* C++ ABI::             Controlling C++ ABI changes.
55* Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
56* Misc::                Everything else.
57@end menu
58
59@node Target Structure
60@section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
61@cindex target hooks
62@cindex target functions
63
64@deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
65The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
66which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
67machine.  The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
68@file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
69used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
70for elements of the structure.  The @file{.c} file should override those
71macros for which the default definition is inappropriate.  For example:
72@smallexample
73#include "target.h"
74#include "target-def.h"
75
76/* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.}  */
77
78#undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
79#define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
80
81struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
82@end smallexample
83@end deftypevar
84
85Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
86form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
87``Target Hook'' with a prototype.  Many macros will change in future
88from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
89@code{targetm} structure.
90
91Similarly, there is a @code{targetcm} variable for hooks that are
92specific to front ends for C-family languages, documented as ``C
93Target Hook''.  This is declared in @file{c-family/c-target.h}, the
94initializer @code{TARGETCM_INITIALIZER} in
95@file{c-family/c-target-def.h}.  If targets initialize @code{targetcm}
96themselves, they should set @code{target_has_targetcm=yes} in
97@file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default definition is used.
98
99Similarly, there is a @code{targetm_common} variable for hooks that
100are shared between the compiler driver and the compilers proper,
101documented as ``Common Target Hook''.  This is declared in
102@file{common/common-target.h}, the initializer
103@code{TARGETM_COMMON_INITIALIZER} in
104@file{common/common-target-def.h}.  If targets initialize
105@code{targetm_common} themselves, they should set
106@code{target_has_targetm_common=yes} in @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a
107default definition is used.
108
109@node Driver
110@section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
111@cindex driver
112@cindex controlling the compilation driver
113
114@c prevent bad page break with this line
115You can control the compilation driver.
116
117@defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
118A list of specs for the driver itself.  It should be a suitable
119initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
120
121The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
122default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
123choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands.  It
124applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
125options added by earlier ones.  It is also possible to remove options
126using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
127
128This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
129options.  It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
130that the other specs are easier to write.
131
132Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
133@end defmac
134
135@defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
136A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
137@option{--with} options) in the driver.  It should be a suitable initializer
138for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
139outermost pair of surrounding braces.
140
141The first item in the pair is the name of the default.  This must match
142the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target.  The second item is a spec
143to apply if a default with this name was specified.  The string
144@samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
145everywhere it occurs.
146
147The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
148default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
149the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
150
151Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
152@end defmac
153
154@defmac CPP_SPEC
155A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
156pass to CPP@.  It can also specify how to translate options you
157give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
158
159Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
160@end defmac
161
162@defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
163This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
164than C@.  If you do not define this macro, then the value of
165@code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
166@end defmac
167
168@defmac CC1_SPEC
169A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
170pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
171front ends.
172It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
173for GCC to pass to front ends.
174
175Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
176@end defmac
177
178@defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
179A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
180pass to @code{cc1plus}.  It can also specify how to translate options you
181give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
182
183Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
184Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
185@code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
186CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
187@end defmac
188
189@defmac ASM_SPEC
190A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
191pass to the assembler.  It can also specify how to translate options
192you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
193See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
194
195Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
196@end defmac
197
198@defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
199A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
200run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
201Normally, this is not needed.  See the file @file{mips.h} for
202an example of this.
203
204Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
205@end defmac
206
207@defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
208Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
209an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
210read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
211output of the compiler proper).  This argument is given after any
212@option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
213
214If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
215standard input if given no non-option arguments.  If your assembler
216cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
217see @file{mips.h} for instance.
218@end defmac
219
220@defmac LINK_SPEC
221A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
222pass to the linker.  It can also specify how to translate options you
223give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
224
225Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
226@end defmac
227
228@defmac LIB_SPEC
229Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}.  The difference
230between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
231command given to the linker.
232
233If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
234loads the standard C library from the usual place.  See @file{gcc.c}.
235@end defmac
236
237@defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
238Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
239how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
240linker command line.  This constant is placed both before and after
241the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
242
243If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
244passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
245@end defmac
246
247@defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
248By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
249@code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
250instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
251depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
252@option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}.  On
253targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
254@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead.  @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
255driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
256line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
257@end defmac
258
259@defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
260A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
261mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.  If nonzero, a spec will be
262generated that uses @option{--as-needed} or equivalent options and the
263shared @file{libgcc} in place of the
264static exception handler library, when linking without any of
265@code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
266@end defmac
267
268@defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
269If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
270When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
271the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
272@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
273@end defmac
274
275@defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
276Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}.  The
277difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
278the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
279
280If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
281standard C startup file from the usual place.  See @file{gcc.c}.
282@end defmac
283
284@defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
285Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}.  The
286difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
287the very end of the command given to the linker.
288
289Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
290@end defmac
291
292@defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
293GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
294However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
295models, such as AIX 4.3.  On such platforms, define
296@code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
297blanks that names one of the recognized thread models.  @code{%*}, the
298default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
299@code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
300@end defmac
301
302@defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
303Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
304configured with a sysroot.  This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
305et al, within sysroot+suffix.
306@end defmac
307
308@defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
309Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
310GCC is configured with a sysroot.  This will cause GCC to pass the
311updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
312usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
313@end defmac
314
315@defmac EXTRA_SPECS
316Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
317@file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
318@code{CC1_SPEC}.
319
320The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
321containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
322string constant that provides the specification.
323
324Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
325
326@code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
327related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
328to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
329these definitions.
330
331For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
332define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
333used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
334used.
335
336The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
337
338@smallexample
339#define EXTRA_SPECS \
340  @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
341
342#define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
343@end smallexample
344
345The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
346@smallexample
347#undef CPP_SPEC
348#define CPP_SPEC \
349"%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
350%@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
351%@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
352%@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
353
354#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
355#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
356@end smallexample
357
358while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
359@code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
360
361@smallexample
362#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
363#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
364@end smallexample
365@end defmac
366
367@defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
368Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
369@file{libgcc.a}.  If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
370the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
371@end defmac
372
373@defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
374The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
375By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
376@end defmac
377
378@defmac POST_LINK_SPEC
379Define this macro to add additional steps to be executed after linker.
380The default value of this macro is empty string.
381@end defmac
382
383@defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
384A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
385linker.  When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
386change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}.  Therefore,
387define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
388line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
389the effect you need.  Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
390@code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
391@end defmac
392
393@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALWAYS_STRIP_DOTDOT
394True if @file{..} components should always be removed from directory names computed relative to GCC's internal directories, false (default) if such components should be preserved and directory names containing them passed to other tools such as the linker.
395@end deftypevr
396
397@defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
398Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
399string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
400target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
401@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
402
403Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
404the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
405@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
406@xref{Target Fragment}.
407@end defmac
408
409@defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
410Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
411a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
412indicates an absolute file name.
413@end defmac
414
415@defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
416If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
417@code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}.  @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
418when the compiler is built as a cross
419compiler.  If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
420to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.ac}.
421@end defmac
422
423@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
424Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
425standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
426try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
427@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
428is built as a cross compiler.
429@end defmac
430
431@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
432Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
433standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
434when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
435@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
436is built as a cross compiler.
437@end defmac
438
439@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
440Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
441standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
442default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
443@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
444is built as a cross compiler.
445@end defmac
446
447@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
448If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
449standard prefixes.  @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
450compiler is built as a cross compiler.
451@end defmac
452
453@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
454If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
455standard prefixes.  It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
456cross compiler.
457@end defmac
458
459@defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
460Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
461variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
462loader.  The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
463initialize the necessary environment variables.
464@end defmac
465
466@defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
467Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
468standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
469try when searching for local header files.  @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
470comes before @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR} (set in
471@file{config.gcc}, normally @file{/usr/include}) in the search order.
472
473Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
474replacement.
475@end defmac
476
477@defmac NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_COMPONENT
478The ``component'' corresponding to @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}.
479See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
480If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
481@end defmac
482
483@defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
484Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
485for include files.  For a native compiler, the default search path
486usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
487@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
488@code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}.  In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
489and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
490and specify private search areas for GCC@.  The directory
491@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
492
493The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
494Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
495string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
496for C++-only directories,
497and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
498wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++.  Mark the end of
499the array with a null element.
500
501The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
502if any, in all uppercase letters.  For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
503or @samp{BINUTILS}.  If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
504operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
505
506For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
507
508@smallexample
509#define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
510@{                                       \
511  @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@},   \
512  @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@},    \
513  @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@},  \
514  @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@},                      \
515  @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@}                         \
516@}
517@end smallexample
518@end defmac
519
520Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
521
522@enumerate
523@item
524Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
525
526@item
527The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
528is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
529@var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
530
531@item
532The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
533
534@item
535The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
536in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
537
538@item
539The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
540
541@item
542The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
543
544@item
545The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
546compiler.
547@end enumerate
548
549Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
550
551@enumerate
552@item
553Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
554
555@item
556The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
557value based on the installed toolchain location.
558
559@item
560The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
561(or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
562
563@item
564The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
565in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
566
567@item
568The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
569
570@item
571The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
572compiler.
573
574@item
575The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
576native compiler, or we have a target system root.
577
578@item
579The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
580native compiler, or we have a target system root.
581
582@item
583The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
584If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
585the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
586
587@item
588The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
589compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
590@file{/lib/}.
591
592@item
593The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
594compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
595@file{/usr/lib/}.
596@end enumerate
597
598@node Run-time Target
599@section Run-time Target Specification
600@cindex run-time target specification
601@cindex predefined macros
602@cindex target specifications
603
604@c prevent bad page break with this line
605Here are run-time target specifications.
606
607@defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
608This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
609built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
610the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
611@code{builtin_assert}.  When the front end
612calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
613finished command line option processing your code can use those
614results freely.
615
616@code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
617command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
618the assertion.  @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
619accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
620
621@code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
622object-like macro.  If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
623@code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally.  Otherwise, it
624defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
625with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
626only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line.  For
627example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
628and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
629@code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
630defines only @code{_ABI64}.
631
632You can also test for the C dialect being compiled.  The variable
633@code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
634or @code{clk_objective_c}.  Note that if we are preprocessing
635assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
636macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
637to check for that first.  If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
638variable @code{flag_iso} can be used.  The function-like macro
639@code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
640preprocessing.
641@end defmac
642
643@defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
644Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
645and is used for the target operating system instead.
646@end defmac
647
648@defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
649Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
650and is used for the target object format.  @file{elfos.h} uses this
651macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
652it yourself.
653@end defmac
654
655@deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
656This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
657any target-specific headers.
658@end deftypevar
659
660@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} int TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
661This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
662Its default setting is 0.
663@end deftypevr
664
665@cindex optional hardware or system features
666@cindex features, optional, in system conventions
667
668@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts_set}, const struct cl_decoded_option *@var{decoded}, location_t @var{loc})
669This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
670target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
671(@pxref{Options}).  It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
672processing and should return true if the option is valid.  The default
673definition does nothing but return true.
674
675@var{decoded} specifies the option and its arguments.  @var{opts} and
676@var{opts_set} are the @code{gcc_options} structures to be used for
677storing option state, and @var{loc} is the location at which the
678option was passed (@code{UNKNOWN_LOCATION} except for options passed
679via attributes).
680@end deftypefn
681
682@deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION (size_t @var{code}, const char *@var{arg}, int @var{value})
683This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
684target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
685definition files(@pxref{Options}).  It has the opportunity to do some
686option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
687valid.  The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}.  The
688default definition does nothing but return false.
689
690In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
691options.  However, if processing an option requires routines that are
692only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
693should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
694@end deftypefn
695
696@deftypefn {C Target Hook} tree TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT (tree @var{string})
697Targets may provide a string object type that can be used within and between C, C++ and their respective Objective-C dialects. A string object might, for example, embed encoding and length information. These objects are considered opaque to the compiler and handled as references. An ideal implementation makes the composition of the string object match that of the Objective-C @code{NSString} (@code{NXString} for GNUStep), allowing efficient interworking between C-only and Objective-C code. If a target implements string objects then this hook should return a reference to such an object constructed from the normal `C' string representation provided in @var{string}. At present, the hook is used by Objective-C only, to obtain a common-format string object when the target provides one.
698@end deftypefn
699
700@deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_CLASS_REFERENCE (const char *@var{classname})
701Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is referenced  by the current TU.
702@end deftypefn
703
704@deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_CLASS_DEFINITION (const char *@var{classname})
705Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is defined  by the current TU.
706@end deftypefn
707
708@deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P (const_tree @var{stringref})
709If a target implements string objects then this hook should return @code{true} if @var{stringref} is a valid reference to such an object.
710@end deftypefn
711
712@deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG (tree @var{format_arg}, tree @var{args_list})
713If a target implements string objects then this hook should should  provide a facility to check the function arguments in @var{args_list}  against the format specifiers in @var{format_arg} where the type of  @var{format_arg} is one recognized as a valid string reference type.
714@end deftypefn
715
716@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE (void)
717This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
718but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
719pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
720attribute or pragma.  It is not called at the beginning of compilation
721when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
722actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
723@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
724@end deftypefn
725
726@defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
727This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
728but is only used in the C
729language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
730used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
731frontends.
732@end defmac
733
734@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} {const struct default_options *} TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
735Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
736various optimization levels.   This variable, if defined, describes
737options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels.  These
738options are processed once
739just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
740of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
741options passed explicitly.
742
743This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
744options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
745@code{optimize} attribute.
746@end deftypevr
747
748@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
749Set target-dependent initial values of fields in @var{opts}.
750@end deftypefn
751
752@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS (void)
753Set target-dependent default values for @option{--param} settings, using calls to @code{set_default_param_value}.
754@end deftypefn
755
756@defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
757Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
758during compilation.  For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
759the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16.  Source code
760can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
761and @code{nomips16} attributes.
762
763Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
764registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
765operations, and so on.  GCC caches a lot of this type of information
766in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
767significant amount of time.  The compiler therefore provides a facility
768for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
769switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
770
771Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility.  The default
772is 0.
773@end defmac
774
775@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FLOAT_EXCEPTIONS_ROUNDING_SUPPORTED_P (void)
776Returns true if the target supports IEEE 754 floating-point exceptions and rounding modes, false otherwise.  This is intended to relate to the @code{float} and @code{double} types, but not necessarily @code{long double}. By default, returns true if the @code{adddf3} instruction pattern is available and false otherwise, on the assumption that hardware floating point supports exceptions and rounding modes but software floating point does not.
777@end deftypefn
778
779@node Per-Function Data
780@section Defining data structures for per-function information.
781@cindex per-function data
782@cindex data structures
783
784If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
785provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this.  Note, just
786using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
787nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
788when another one comes along.
789
790GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
791contains all of the data specific to an individual function.  This
792structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
793@code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
794to their own specific data.
795
796If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
797@code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
798This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
799@code{init_machine_status}.  This pointer is explained below.
800
801One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
802RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address.  This
803RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
804function, for level 0.
805
806Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
807all of the per-function information.  Thus when processing of a nested
808function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
809stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
810stack.  GCC used to provide function pointers called
811@code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
812the saving and restoring of the target specific information.  Since the
813single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
814longer supported.
815
816@defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
817Macro called to initialize any target specific information.  This macro
818is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
819The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
820function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
821@end defmac
822
823@deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
824If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
825function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
826target to perform any target specific initialization of the
827@code{struct function} structure.  It is intended that this would be
828used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
829
830@code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
831Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
832GC allocation, including the structure itself.
833@end deftypevar
834
835@node Storage Layout
836@section Storage Layout
837@cindex storage layout
838
839Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
840alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant.  They can be C
841expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
842@xref{Run-time Target}.
843
844@defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
845Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
846byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
847This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
848bit.  If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
849be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to.  This
850macro need not be a constant.
851
852This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
853bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
854@end defmac
855
856@defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
857Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
858word has the lowest number.  This macro need not be a constant.
859@end defmac
860
861@defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
862Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
863most significant word has the lowest number.  This applies to both
864memory locations and registers; see @code{REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} if the
865order of words in memory is not the same as the order in registers.  This
866macro need not be a constant.
867@end defmac
868
869@defmac REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
870On some machines, the order of words in a multiword object differs between
871registers in memory.  In such a situation, define this macro to describe
872the order of words in a register.  The macro @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} controls
873the order of words in memory.
874@end defmac
875
876@defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
877Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
878@code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
879containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
880have the value 0.  This macro need not be a constant.
881
882You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
883multi-word integers.
884@end defmac
885
886@defmac BITS_PER_WORD
887Number of bits in a word.  If you do not define this macro, the default
888is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
889@end defmac
890
891@defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
892Maximum number of bits in a word.  If this is undefined, the default is
893@code{BITS_PER_WORD}.  Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
894largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
895@end defmac
896
897@defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
898Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
899register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
900@end defmac
901
902@defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
903Minimum number of units in a word.  If this is undefined, the default is
904@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}.  Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
905smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
906@end defmac
907
908@defmac POINTER_SIZE
909Width of a pointer, in bits.  You must specify a value no wider than the
910width of @code{Pmode}.  If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
911you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}.  If you do not specify
912a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
913@end defmac
914
915@defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
916A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
917@code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}.  It is
918greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
919should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
920is needed.  In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
921@code{ptr_extend} instruction.
922
923You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
924and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
925@end defmac
926
927@defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
928A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
929is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
930stored in a register.  This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
931scalar type.
932
933On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
934register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
935@var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.  In most
936cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
937floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
938counterparts.
939
940For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
941However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
942either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes.  For example, on
943the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
944sign-extend the result to 64 bits.  On such machines, set
945@var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
946
947Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
948@end defmac
949
950@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum flt_eval_method} TARGET_C_EXCESS_PRECISION (enum excess_precision_type @var{type})
951Return a value, with the same meaning as the C99 macro @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} that describes which excess precision should be applied.  @var{type} is either @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_IMPLICIT}, @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_FAST}, or @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_STANDARD}.  For @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_IMPLICIT}, the target should return which precision and range operations will be implictly evaluated in regardless of the excess precision explicitly added.  For @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_STANDARD} and @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_FAST}, the target should return the explicit excess precision that should be added depending on the value set for @option{-fexcess-precision=@r{[}standard@r{|}fast@r{]}}. Note that unpredictable explicit excess precision does not make sense, so a target should never return @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD_UNPREDICTABLE} when @var{type} is @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_STANDARD} or @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_FAST}.
952@end deftypefn
953
954@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE (const_tree @var{type}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int *@var{punsignedp}, const_tree @var{funtype}, int @var{for_return})
955Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
956function return values.  The target hook should return the new mode
957and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
958change signedness.  This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
959pointer} types.
960
961@var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
962return values.  If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
963@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
964If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
965which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
966then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
967the signedness may be different.
968
969@var{type} can be NULL when promoting function arguments of libcalls.
970
971The default is to not promote arguments and return values.  You can
972also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
973if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
974@end deftypefn
975
976@defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
977Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
978bits.  All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
979regardless of data type.  On most machines, this is the same as the
980size of an integer.
981@end defmac
982
983@defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
984Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
985stack pointer on this machine.  The definition is a C expression for the
986desired alignment (measured in bits).  This value is used as a default
987if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined.  On most machines,
988this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
989@end defmac
990
991@defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
992Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
993stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces.  The definition
994is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits).  This
995macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
996@code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
997@end defmac
998
999@defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
1000Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
1001from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.  This macro must evaluate
1002to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1003@end defmac
1004
1005@defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1006Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
1007@end defmac
1008
1009@defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1010Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
1011bits.  Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
1012just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
1013@end defmac
1014
1015@deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_ABSOLUTE_BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1016If defined, this target hook specifies the absolute biggest alignment
1017that a type or variable can have on this machine, otherwise,
1018@code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} is used.
1019@end deftypevr
1020
1021@defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1022Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1023provide.  If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1024@end defmac
1025
1026@defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1027Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct.  If
1028not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1029@end defmac
1030
1031@defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1032If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1033object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1034nearby object.  Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1035on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1036@end defmac
1037
1038@defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1039Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1040machine, in bits.  If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1041structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1042by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1043@end defmac
1044
1045@defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{type}, @var{computed})
1046An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} of
1047type @var{type} if the alignment computed in the usual way (including
1048applying of @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1049alignment) is @var{computed}.  It overrides alignment only if the
1050field alignment has not been set by the
1051@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.  Note that @var{field}
1052may be @code{NULL_TREE} in case we just query for the minimum alignment
1053of a field of type @var{type} in structure context.
1054@end defmac
1055
1056@defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1057Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend.  Use this macro
1058to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1059
1060If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1061
1062@c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1063@c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1064@c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1065@c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1066@end defmac
1067
1068@defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1069Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1070Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1071@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.  If not defined,
1072the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1073
1074On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1075the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1076a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((uint64_t) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1077On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1078@samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1079@end defmac
1080
1081@deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_STATIC_RTX_ALIGNMENT (machine_mode @var{mode})
1082This hook returns the preferred alignment in bits for a
1083statically-allocated rtx, such as a constant pool entry.  @var{mode}
1084is the mode of the rtx.  The default implementation returns
1085@samp{GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (@var{mode})}.
1086@end deftypefn
1087
1088@defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1089If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1090the static store.  @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1091the alignment that the object would ordinarily have.  The value of this
1092macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1093
1094If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1095
1096@findex strcpy
1097One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1098make it all fit in fewer cache lines.  Another is to cause character
1099arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1100constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1101@end defmac
1102
1103@defmac DATA_ABI_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1104Similar to @code{DATA_ALIGNMENT}, but for the cases where the ABI mandates
1105some alignment increase, instead of optimization only purposes.  E.g.@
1106AMD x86-64 psABI says that variables with array type larger than 15 bytes
1107must be aligned to 16 byte boundaries.
1108
1109If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1110@end defmac
1111
1112@deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (const_tree @var{constant}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{basic_align})
1113This hook returns the alignment in bits of a constant that is being
1114placed in memory.  @var{constant} is the constant and @var{basic_align}
1115is the alignment that the object would ordinarily have.
1116
1117The default definition just returns @var{basic_align}.
1118
1119The typical use of this hook is to increase alignment for string
1120constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1121constants can be done inline.  The function
1122@code{constant_alignment_word_strings} provides such a definition.
1123@end deftypefn
1124
1125@defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1126If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1127the local store.  @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1128the alignment that the object would ordinarily have.  The value of this
1129macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1130
1131If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1132
1133One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1134make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1135
1136If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1137@end defmac
1138
1139@deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT (const_tree @var{type})
1140This hook can be used to define the alignment for a vector of type
1141@var{type}, in order to comply with a platform ABI.  The default is to
1142require natural alignment for vector types.  The alignment returned by
1143this hook must be a power-of-two multiple of the default alignment of
1144the vector element type.
1145@end deftypefn
1146
1147@defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1148If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1149@var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1150and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1151have.  The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1152align the slot.
1153
1154If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1155@var{type} is @code{NULL}.  Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1156be used.
1157
1158This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1159of all possible modes which the slot may have.
1160
1161If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1162@end defmac
1163
1164@defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1165If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1166variable @var{decl}.
1167
1168If this macro is not defined, then
1169@code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1170is used.
1171
1172One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1173make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1174
1175If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1176@end defmac
1177
1178@defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1179If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1180for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1181@var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1182
1183If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1184@end defmac
1185
1186@defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1187Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1188empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1189
1190If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1191@end defmac
1192
1193@defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1194Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1195Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1196
1197If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1198@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1199@end defmac
1200
1201@defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1202Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1203if given data not on the nominal alignment.  If instructions will merely
1204go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1205@end defmac
1206
1207@defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1208Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1209alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1210
1211The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1212@code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1213structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1214that type.  In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1215that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1216
1217Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1218@code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1219four-byte alignment for the whole structure.  (The alignment used may
1220not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1221
1222An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1223structure.
1224
1225If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1226a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1227
1228Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1229bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary.  The compiler can
1230support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1231@samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1232
1233The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1234@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1235Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1236
1237Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1238@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1239@code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1240
1241If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1242bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1243what the other compiler does.  Compile and run this program:
1244
1245@smallexample
1246struct foo1
1247@{
1248  char x;
1249  char :0;
1250  char y;
1251@};
1252
1253struct foo2
1254@{
1255  char x;
1256  int :0;
1257  char y;
1258@};
1259
1260main ()
1261@{
1262  printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1263          sizeof (struct foo1));
1264  printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1265          sizeof (struct foo2));
1266  exit (0);
1267@}
1268@end smallexample
1269
1270If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1271get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1272@end defmac
1273
1274@defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1275Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1276to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1277@end defmac
1278
1279@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD (void)
1280When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1281whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1282structure.  The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1283the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1284@end deftypefn
1285
1286@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD (void)
1287This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1288should use the narrowest mode possible.  It should return @code{false} if
1289these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1290
1291The default is @code{false}.
1292@end deftypefn
1293
1294@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (const_tree @var{field}, machine_mode @var{mode})
1295Return true if a structure, union or array containing @var{field} should
1296be accessed using @code{BLKMODE}.
1297
1298If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1299mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode.  @var{mode} is provided in the
1300case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1301retain the field's mode.
1302
1303Normally, this is not needed.
1304@end deftypefn
1305
1306@defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1307Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1308by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1309way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1310@var{specified}.
1311
1312The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1313the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1314@end defmac
1315
1316@defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1317An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1318machine mode that should actually be used.  All integer machine modes of
1319this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1320appropriate sizes.  If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1321(DImode)} is assumed.
1322@end defmac
1323
1324@defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1325If defined, an expression of type @code{machine_mode} that
1326specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1327@code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1328@var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1329@code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1330having its mode specified.
1331
1332You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}.  You
1333would most commonly define this macro if the
1334@code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
133564-bit mode.
1336@end defmac
1337
1338@defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1339If defined, an expression of type @code{machine_mode} that
1340specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1341@code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1342
1343You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1344You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1345pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1346@end defmac
1347
1348@deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE (void)
1349This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1350of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls.  If not defined
1351@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1352targets.
1353@end deftypefn
1354
1355@deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE (void)
1356This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1357of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls.  If not defined
1358@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1359targets.
1360@end deftypefn
1361
1362@deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE (void)
1363Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1364The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1365@end deftypefn
1366
1367@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P (const_tree @var{record_type})
1368This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1369@var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1370Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1371unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1372different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1373alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1374bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1375the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1376(iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1377another bit-field of nonzero size.  If this hook returns @code{true},
1378other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1379
1380When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1381of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1382bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1383and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1384chunk of 32 bits.  However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1385size is allocated).  In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1386alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1387
1388If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1389the latter will take precedence.  If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1390used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1391precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1392may affect its placement.
1393@end deftypefn
1394
1395@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1396Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1397@end deftypefn
1398
1399@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1400Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1401@end deftypefn
1402
1403@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK (void)
1404This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1405to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1406For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1407for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1408registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1409usage.
1410@end deftypefn
1411
1412@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS (void)
1413This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1414that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1415@end deftypefn
1416
1417@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
1418If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1419uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1420to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1421mangled name.  The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1422the type to be mangled.  The hook may be applied to trees which are
1423not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1424for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize.  If the
1425return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1426string constant.
1427
1428Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1429qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types.  Encode new
1430fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1431is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1432length of @var{name} in decimal.  Encode qualified versions of
1433ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1434@var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1435@var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1436code used to represent the unqualified version of this type.  (See
1437@code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1438codes.)  In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1439spaces in your string.
1440
1441This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution.  If the mangled
1442name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1443can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1444before mangling.
1445
1446The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1447appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1448types.
1449@end deftypefn
1450
1451@node Type Layout
1452@section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1453
1454These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1455basic data types used in programs being compiled.  Unlike the macros in
1456the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1457languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1458
1459@defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1460A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1461target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1462@end defmac
1463
1464@defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1465A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1466target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1467(If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1468unit.)
1469@end defmac
1470
1471@defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1472A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1473target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1474@end defmac
1475
1476@defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1477On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1478@code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@.  In
1479that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1480the size of that type.  If you don't define this, the default is the
1481value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1482@end defmac
1483
1484@defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1485A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1486target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is two
1487words.  If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1488macro must be at least 64.
1489@end defmac
1490
1491@defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1492A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1493target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is
1494@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1495@end defmac
1496
1497@defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1498A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1499C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine.  If you don't define
1500this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1501@end defmac
1502
1503@defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1504A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1505target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1506@end defmac
1507
1508@defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1509A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1510target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is two
1511words.
1512@end defmac
1513
1514@defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1515A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1516the target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is two
1517words.
1518@end defmac
1519
1520@defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1521A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1522the target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is
1523@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1524@end defmac
1525
1526@defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1527A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1528the target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is
1529@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1530@end defmac
1531
1532@defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1533A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1534the target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is
1535@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1536@end defmac
1537
1538@defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1539A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1540the target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is
1541@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1542@end defmac
1543
1544@defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1545A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1546the target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is
1547@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1548@end defmac
1549
1550@defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1551A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1552the target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is
1553@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1554@end defmac
1555
1556@defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1557A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1558the target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is
1559@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1560@end defmac
1561
1562@defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1563A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1564the target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is
1565@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1566@end defmac
1567
1568@defmac LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX
1569This macro corresponds to the @code{TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX} target
1570hook and should be defined if that hook is overriden to be true.  It
1571causes function names in libgcc to be changed to use a @code{__gnu_}
1572prefix for their name rather than the default @code{__}.  A port which
1573uses this macro should also arrange to use @file{t-gnu-prefix} in
1574the libgcc @file{config.host}.
1575@end defmac
1576
1577@defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1578A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1579supported by the hardware.  If you define this macro, you must specify a
1580value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1581If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1582is the default.
1583@end defmac
1584
1585@defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1586An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1587@code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default.  The user can
1588always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1589and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1590@end defmac
1591
1592@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS (void)
1593This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1594@code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1595of possible values of that type.  It should return false if all
1596@code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1597
1598The default is to return false.
1599@end deftypefn
1600
1601@defmac SIZE_TYPE
1602A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1603for size values.  The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1604contents of the string.
1605
1606The string can contain more than one keyword.  If so, separate them with
1607spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1608appropriate, and finally @code{int}.  The string must exactly match one
1609of the data type names defined in the function
1610@code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins} in the file @file{c-family/c-common.c}.
1611You may not omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the
1612compiler to crash on startup.
1613
1614If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1615int"}.
1616@end defmac
1617
1618@defmac SIZETYPE
1619GCC defines internal types (@code{sizetype}, @code{ssizetype},
1620@code{bitsizetype} and @code{sbitsizetype}) for expressions
1621dealing with size.  This macro is a C expression for a string describing
1622the name of the data type from which the precision of @code{sizetype}
1623is extracted.
1624
1625The string has the same restrictions as @code{SIZE_TYPE} string.
1626
1627If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{SIZE_TYPE}.
1628@end defmac
1629
1630@defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1631A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1632for the result of subtracting two pointers.  The typedef name
1633@code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string.  See
1634@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1635
1636If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1637@end defmac
1638
1639@defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1640A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1641for wide characters.  The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1642the contents of the string.  See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1643information.
1644
1645If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1646@end defmac
1647
1648@defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1649A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1650characters.  This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1651@code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1652@end defmac
1653
1654@defmac WINT_TYPE
1655A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1656use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1657@code{getwc}.  The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1658contents of the string.  See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1659information.
1660
1661If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1662@end defmac
1663
1664@defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1665A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1666can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1667The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1668string.  See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1669
1670If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1671@code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1672much precision as @code{long long int}.
1673@end defmac
1674
1675@defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1676A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1677can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1678type.  The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1679of the string.  See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1680
1681If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1682@code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1683unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1684int}.
1685@end defmac
1686
1687@defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1688@defmacx INT8_TYPE
1689@defmacx INT16_TYPE
1690@defmacx INT32_TYPE
1691@defmacx INT64_TYPE
1692@defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1693@defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1694@defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1695@defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1696@defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1697@defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1698@defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1699@defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1700@defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1701@defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1702@defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1703@defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1704@defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1705@defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1706@defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1707@defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1708@defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1709@defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1710@defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1711@defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1712@defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1713@defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1714C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1715@code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1716@code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1717@code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1718@code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1719@code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1720@code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1721@code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1722@code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}.  See
1723@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1724
1725If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1726type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1727@code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1728to C99, depending on the type in question.  The defaults for all of
1729these macros are null pointers.
1730@end defmac
1731
1732@defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1733The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1734that looks like:
1735
1736@smallexample
1737  struct @{
1738    union @{
1739      void (*fn)();
1740      ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1741    @};
1742    ptrdiff_t delta;
1743  @};
1744@end smallexample
1745
1746@noindent
1747The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1748will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1749Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1750always be zero.  Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1751distinguish which variant of the union is in use.  But, on some
1752platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work.  In
1753that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1754the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1755
1756GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1757this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1758However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1759set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1760bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1761address is in ARM or Thumb mode.  If this is the case of your
1762architecture, you should define this macro to
1763@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1764
1765In general, you should not have to define this macro.  On architectures
1766in which function addresses are always even, according to
1767@code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1768@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1769@end defmac
1770
1771@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1772Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables.  This
1773macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1774instead.  Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1775function pointer is actually a small data structure.  Normally the
1776data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1777pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1778
1779If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1780of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1781@end defmac
1782
1783@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1784By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1785is the same as pointer alignment.  The value of this macro specifies
1786the alignment of the vtable entry in bits.  It should be defined only
1787when special alignment is necessary. */
1788@end defmac
1789
1790@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1791There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1792zero.  If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1793specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1794of words in each data entry.
1795@end defmac
1796
1797@node Registers
1798@section Register Usage
1799@cindex register usage
1800
1801This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1802has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1803
1804The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1805done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}.  For information
1806on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1807For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1808For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1809
1810@menu
1811* Register Basics::             Number and kinds of registers.
1812* Allocation Order::            Order in which registers are allocated.
1813* Values in Registers::         What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1814* Leaf Functions::              Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1815* Stack Registers::             Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1816@end menu
1817
1818@node Register Basics
1819@subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1820
1821@c prevent bad page break with this line
1822Registers have various characteristics.
1823
1824@defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1825Number of hardware registers known to the compiler.  They receive
1826numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1827pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1828@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1829@end defmac
1830
1831@defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1832@cindex fixed register
1833An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1834all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1835general allocation.  These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1836pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1837register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1838machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1839and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1840
1841This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1842commas and surrounded by braces.  The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1843register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1844
1845The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1846the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1847by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1848the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1849@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1850@end defmac
1851
1852@defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1853@cindex call-used register
1854@cindex call-clobbered register
1855@cindex call-saved register
1856Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1857clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1858registers.  This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1859available for general allocation of values that must live across
1860function calls.
1861
1862If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1863automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1864exit, if the register is used within the function.
1865@end defmac
1866
1867@defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1868@cindex call-used register
1869@cindex call-clobbered register
1870@cindex call-saved register
1871Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1872that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1873(@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1874This macro is optional.  If not specified, it defaults to the value
1875of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1876@end defmac
1877
1878@cindex call-used register
1879@cindex call-clobbered register
1880@cindex call-saved register
1881@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (unsigned int @var{regno}, machine_mode @var{mode})
1882This hook should return true if @var{regno} is partly call-saved and
1883partly call-clobbered, and if a value of mode @var{mode} would be partly
1884clobbered by a call.  For example, if the low 32 bits of @var{regno} are
1885preserved across a call but higher bits are clobbered, this hook should
1886return true for a 64-bit mode but false for a 32-bit mode.
1887
1888The default implementation returns false, which is correct
1889for targets that don't have partly call-clobbered registers.
1890@end deftypefn
1891
1892@findex fixed_regs
1893@findex call_used_regs
1894@findex global_regs
1895@findex reg_names
1896@findex reg_class_contents
1897@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE (void)
1898This hook may conditionally modify five variables
1899@code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1900@code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1901any dependence of these register sets on target flags.  The first three
1902of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as boolean vectors).
1903@code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1904@code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}.  Before the macro is
1905called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1906@code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1907from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1908@code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1909@code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1910@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1911command options have been applied.
1912
1913@cindex disabling certain registers
1914@cindex controlling register usage
1915If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1916flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1917@code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1918registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@.  Also make
1919@code{define_register_constraint}s return @code{NO_REGS} for constraints
1920that shouldn't be used.
1921
1922(However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1923of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1924controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1925these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
1926@end deftypefn
1927
1928@defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1929Define this macro if the target machine has register windows.  This C
1930expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1931corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1932function.  Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1933outbound register.
1934@end defmac
1935
1936@defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1937Define this macro if the target machine has register windows.  This C
1938expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1939corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1940function.  Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1941register.
1942@end defmac
1943
1944@defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1945Define this macro if the target machine has register windows.  This C
1946expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1947register window.  Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1948need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1949gotos.
1950@end defmac
1951
1952@defmac PC_REGNUM
1953If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1954register number.  Otherwise, do not define it.
1955@end defmac
1956
1957@node Allocation Order
1958@subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1959@cindex order of register allocation
1960@cindex register allocation order
1961
1962@c prevent bad page break with this line
1963Registers are allocated in order.
1964
1965@defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1966If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
1967numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
1968to use them (from most preferred to least).
1969
1970If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
1971(all else being equal).
1972
1973One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
1974registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
1975instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers.  On such
1976machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
1977the highest numbered allocable register first.
1978@end defmac
1979
1980@defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1981A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
1982hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
1983
1984Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
1985Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
1986register; and so on.
1987
1988The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
1989@code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
1990
1991On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
1992@end defmac
1993
1994@defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1995Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
1996prologue and restoring it in the epilogue.  This discourages it from
1997using call-saved registers.  If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
1998allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
1999call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, then define this
2000macro as a C expression to nonzero. Default is 0.
2001@end defmac
2002
2003@defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
2004In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
2005Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
2006If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
2007based on @var{regno}.  The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2008be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2009value returned by this macro.  Not defining this macro is equivalent
2010to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2011
2012On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2013@end defmac
2014
2015@node Values in Registers
2016@subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2017
2018This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2019(specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2020consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2021
2022@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_HARD_REGNO_NREGS (unsigned int @var{regno}, machine_mode @var{mode})
2023This hook returns the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2024at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2025@var{mode}.  This hook must never return zero, even if a register
2026cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with
2027@code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} and/or
2028@code{TARGET_CAN_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} instead.
2029
2030The default definition returns the number of words in @var{mode}.
2031@end deftypefn
2032
2033@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2034A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2035in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2036in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2037multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2038this mode by the number of registers returned by
2039@code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_NREGS}).  By default this is zero.
2040
2041For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2042registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2043nonzero.
2044
2045This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2046@code{subreg_get_info}
2047would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2048represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2049@code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2050registers and so not be representable.
2051@end defmac
2052
2053@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2054For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2055@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2056returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2057including any padding.  In the example above, the value would be four.
2058@end defmac
2059
2060@defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2061Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2062of mode @var{mode} is not the word size.  It is a C expression that
2063should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode.  It is
2064used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results.  This
2065happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2066floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2067@end defmac
2068
2069@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (unsigned int @var{regno}, machine_mode @var{mode})
2070This hook returns true if it is permissible to store a value
2071of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2072registers starting with that one).  The default definition returns true
2073unconditionally.
2074
2075You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2076because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2077
2078@cindex register pairs
2079On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2080register pairs.  You can implement that by defining this hook to reject
2081odd register numbers for such modes.
2082
2083The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2084@samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2085register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2086value into the register and back out not alter it.
2087
2088Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2089all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2090this hook to distinguish between these modes, provided you define
2091patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this.  This is
2092useful because of the interaction between @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2093and @code{TARGET_MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer
2094modes to be tieable.
2095
2096Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2097Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2098in floating point registers.  This is not true.  Any registers that
2099can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2100mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2101registers.  Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2102
2103On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2104modes may not go in floating registers.  This is true if the floating
2105registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2106non-floating value there would garble it.  In this case,
2107@code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2108floating registers.  But if the floating registers do not automatically
2109normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2110unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2111register, so you can define this hook to say so.
2112
2113The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2114they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2115instructions.  However, this is of no concern to
2116@code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.  You handle it by writing the proper
2117constraints for those instructions.
2118
2119On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2120so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2121register if floating point arithmetic is not being done.  As long as the
2122floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2123be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2124@end deftypefn
2125
2126@defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2127A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2128@var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2129
2130One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2131another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2132handler.
2133
2134The default is always nonzero.
2135@end defmac
2136
2137@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MODES_TIEABLE_P (machine_mode @var{mode1}, machine_mode @var{mode2})
2138This hook returns true if a value of mode @var{mode1} is accessible
2139in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2140
2141If @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2142@code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always
2143the same for any @var{r}, then
2144@code{TARGET_MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2145should be true.  If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2146this hook to return false unless some other mechanism ensures the
2147accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2148
2149You should define this hook to return true in as many cases as
2150possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2151allocation.  The default definition returns true unconditionally.
2152@end deftypefn
2153
2154@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK (unsigned int @var{regno})
2155This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2156@var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2157
2158One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2159is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2160
2161The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2162@end deftypefn
2163
2164@defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2165Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2166registers.  You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2167@code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2168@end defmac
2169
2170@node Leaf Functions
2171@subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2172
2173@cindex leaf functions
2174@cindex functions, leaf
2175On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2176more efficiently if it does not make its own register window.  Often this
2177means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2178are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2179normally arrive.
2180
2181The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2182other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2183registers for its own variables and temporaries.  We use the term ``leaf
2184function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2185handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2186functions''.
2187
2188GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2189suitable for leaf function treatment.  So it needs to renumber the
2190registers in order to output a leaf function.  The following macros
2191accomplish this.
2192
2193@defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2194Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2195contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2196function treatment.
2197
2198If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2199registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2200GCC would ordinarily allocate.  The registers which will actually be
2201used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2202in this vector.
2203
2204Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2205the treatment of leaf functions.
2206@end defmac
2207
2208@defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2209A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2210should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2211
2212If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2213function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2214will cause the compiler to abort.
2215
2216Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2217treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2218this.
2219@end defmac
2220
2221@findex current_function_is_leaf
2222@findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2223@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2224@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2225specially.  They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2226which is nonzero for leaf functions.  @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2227set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2228compiler passes.  They can also test the C variable
2229@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2230functions which only use leaf registers.
2231@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2232that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2233@code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2234@c changed this to fix overfull.  ALSO:  why the "it" at the beginning
2235@c of the next paragraph?!  --mew 2feb93
2236
2237@node Stack Registers
2238@subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2239
2240There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2241``registers'' form a stack.  Stack registers are normally written by
2242pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2243stack.
2244
2245Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2246they must be consecutively numbered.  Furthermore, the existing
2247support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2248point coprocessor.  If you have a new architecture that uses
2249stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2250@file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2251with it, as well as defining these macros.
2252
2253@defmac STACK_REGS
2254Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2255@end defmac
2256
2257@defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2258This is a cover class containing the stack registers.  Define this if
2259the machine has any stack-like registers.
2260@end defmac
2261
2262@defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2263The number of the first stack-like register.  This one is the top
2264of the stack.
2265@end defmac
2266
2267@defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2268The number of the last stack-like register.  This one is the bottom of
2269the stack.
2270@end defmac
2271
2272@node Register Classes
2273@section Register Classes
2274@cindex register class definitions
2275@cindex class definitions, register
2276
2277On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2278For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2279certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions.  These machine
2280restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2281
2282You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2283which of the registers belong to it.  Then you can specify register classes
2284that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2285
2286@findex ALL_REGS
2287@findex NO_REGS
2288In general, each register will belong to several classes.  In fact, one
2289class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers.  Another
2290class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers.  Often the
2291union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2292
2293@findex GENERAL_REGS
2294One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}.  There is nothing
2295terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2296@samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class.  If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2297the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2298to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2299
2300Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2301then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2302
2303The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2304constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2305You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2306them in operand constraints.
2307
2308You must define the narrowest register classes for allocatable
2309registers, so that each class either has no subclasses, or that for
2310some mode, the move cost between registers within the class is
2311cheaper than moving a register in the class to or from memory
2312(@pxref{Costs}).
2313
2314You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2315instruction allows both classes.  For example, if an instruction allows
2316either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2317certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2318which includes both of them.  Otherwise you will get suboptimal code,
2319or even internal compiler errors when reload cannot find a register in the
2320class computed via @code{reg_class_subunion}.
2321
2322You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2323classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2324contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2325in their union.
2326
2327When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2328certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2329Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2330a register pair to start with an even-numbered register.  The way to
2331specify this requirement is with @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2332
2333Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2334instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2335each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2336mode to or from memory.  For example, on some machines, the operations for
2337single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers.  When
2338this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2339instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2340single-byte values can be loaded or stored.  This is so that
2341@code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2342
2343@deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2344An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2345as enumerated values.  @code{NO_REGS} must be first.  @code{ALL_REGS}
2346must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2347@code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2348tells how many classes there are.
2349
2350Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2351the class name to type @code{int}.  The number serves as an index
2352in many of the tables described below.
2353@end deftp
2354
2355@defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2356The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2357
2358@smallexample
2359#define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2360@end smallexample
2361@end defmac
2362
2363@defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2364An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2365constants.  These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2366@end defmac
2367
2368@defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2369An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2370which are bit masks.  The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2371@var{n}.  The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2372register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2373
2374When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2375Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2376several integers.  Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2377for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2378In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2379registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2380so on.
2381@end defmac
2382
2383@defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2384A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2385@var{regno}.  In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2386which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2387register.
2388@end defmac
2389
2390@defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2391A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2392base register must belong.  A base register is one used in an address
2393which is the register value plus a displacement.
2394@end defmac
2395
2396@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2397This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2398the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner.  If
2399@var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2400@code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2401@end defmac
2402
2403@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2404A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2405base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2406register address.  You should define this macro if base plus index
2407addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2408@end defmac
2409
2410@defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2411A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2412base register for a memory reference in mode @var{mode} to address
2413space @var{address_space} must belong.  @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code}
2414define the context in which the base register occurs.  @var{outer_code} is
2415the code of the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level
2416of an address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2417@code{address_operand}).  @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2418index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2419@end defmac
2420
2421@defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2422A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2423index register must belong.  An index register is one used in an
2424address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2425added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2426@end defmac
2427
2428@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2429A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2430suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
2431@end defmac
2432
2433@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2434A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2435that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2436@var{mode}.  You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2437reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register.  If
2438you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2439@code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.  The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2440addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2441@code{address_operand}.
2442@end defmac
2443
2444@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2445A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2446use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2447memory in mode @var{mode}.  It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2448pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register.  You should
2449define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2450than other base register uses.
2451
2452Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2453@code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2454@end defmac
2455
2456@defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2457A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2458suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses, accessing
2459memory in mode @var{mode} in address space @var{address_space}.
2460This is similar to @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2461that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2462appears in the memory reference.  @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2463immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2464address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2465@code{address_operand}).  @var{index_code} is the code of the
2466corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2467@code{SCRATCH} otherwise.  The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2468that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
2469@end defmac
2470
2471@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2472A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2473suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses.  It may be
2474either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2475allocated such a hard register.
2476
2477The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2478the index register may be scaled.  If an address involves the sum of
2479two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2480labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2481labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2482may serve in each capacity.  The compiler will try both labelings,
2483looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2484only if neither labeling works.
2485@end defmac
2486
2487@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RENAME_CLASS (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2488A target hook that places additional preference on the register class to use when it is necessary to rename a register in class @var{rclass} to another class, or perhaps @var{NO_REGS}, if no preferred register class is found or hook @code{preferred_rename_class} is not implemented. Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code.  For example, on ARM, thumb-2 instructions using @code{LO_REGS} may be smaller than instructions using @code{GENERIC_REGS}.  By returning @code{LO_REGS} from @code{preferred_rename_class}, code size can be reduced.
2489@end deftypefn
2490
2491@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2492A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2493to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2494@var{rclass}.  The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2495another, smaller class.
2496
2497The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2498
2499Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code.  For
2500example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2501for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2502@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2503Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2504
2505One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2506@var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2507loaded into some register class.  By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2508force @var{x} into a memory location.  For example, rs6000 can load
2509immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2510instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2511register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2512@var{x} is a floating-point constant.  If the constant can't be loaded
2513into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2514@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2515of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2516
2517If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2518through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2519to find the best one.  Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2520reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2521this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2522the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2523@end deftypefn
2524
2525@defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2526A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2527to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2528@var{class}.  The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2529another, smaller class.  On many machines, the following definition is
2530safe:
2531
2532@smallexample
2533#define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2534@end smallexample
2535
2536Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code.  For
2537example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2538for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2539@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2540Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2541
2542One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2543@var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2544loaded into some register class.  By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2545force @var{x} into a memory location.  For example, rs6000 can load
2546immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2547instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2548register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2549@var{x} is a floating-point constant.  If the constant cannot be loaded
2550into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2551@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2552of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2553
2554If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2555through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2556to find the best one.  Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2557reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2558this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2559the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2560@end defmac
2561
2562@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2563Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2564input reloads.
2565
2566The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2567argument.
2568
2569You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2570reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2571@end deftypefn
2572
2573@defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2574A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2575to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2576@var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2577ordinarily be used.
2578
2579Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2580there are certain modes that simply cannot go in certain reload classes.
2581
2582The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2583smaller class.
2584
2585Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2586require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2587@end defmac
2588
2589@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD (bool @var{in_p}, rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{reload_class}, machine_mode @var{reload_mode}, secondary_reload_info *@var{sri})
2590Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2591from memory or even from other types of registers.  An example is the
2592@samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2593from general registers, but not memory.  Below, we shall be using the
2594term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2595directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2596register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2597destination.  An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2598source and destination.  Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2599reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2600and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2601intermediate register still holds the required value.
2602
2603Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2604allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2605register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2606address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2607when compiling PIC)@.  Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2608as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2609that being copied.  Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2610describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2611these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2612of the scratch register(s).
2613
2614In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2615
2616For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2617and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2618@var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}.  For output reloads, this target
2619hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2620needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2621
2622If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2623an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2624return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2625If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2626If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2627that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2628
2629If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2630perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2631closest intermediate register.  Or if no intermediate register is
2632required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2633copy  from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2634
2635You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2636in the md file which performs the move.  Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2637and input of this copy, respectively.  Operands from operand 2 onward are
2638for scratch operands.  These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2639single-register-class
2640@c [later: or memory]
2641output constraint.
2642
2643When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2644hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2645register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2646have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2647
2648@c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2649@c   the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2650@c   and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2651@c   alternative.  A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2652@c   against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2653@c   constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2654@c   arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2655@c   Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2656
2657
2658@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2659pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2660Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2661in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2662
2663Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2664currently not supported.  For the time being, you will have to continue
2665to use @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2666
2667@code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2668copied.  If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2669(a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2670Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2671of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2672forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2673@end deftypefn
2674
2675@defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2676@defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2677@defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2678These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2679@code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2680
2681These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2682target hook.  Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2683reload phase that it may
2684need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2685register to contain the data.  Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2686register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2687you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2688largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2689intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2690
2691If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2692intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2693was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2694class required.  If the
2695requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2696@code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2697macros identically.
2698
2699The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2700Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2701can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2702@var{mode} without requiring a scratch register.  Do not define this
2703macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2704
2705If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2706intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2707@samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2708(@pxref{Standard Names}.  These patterns, which were normally
2709implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2710@samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2711register.
2712
2713These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2714register that
2715contain a single register class.  If the original reload register (whose
2716class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2717value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2718register.  Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2719Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2720
2721@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2722pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2723Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2724in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2725
2726These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2727registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2728registers.  In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2729would not be helpful.  Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2730the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2731intermediate storage.  This case often occurs between floating-point and
2732general registers.
2733@end defmac
2734
2735@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{class1}, reg_class_t @var{class2})
2736Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2737to some other registers without using memory.  Define this hook on
2738those machines to return true if objects of mode @var{m} in registers
2739of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of class @var{class2} by
2740 storing a register of @var{class1} into memory and loading that memory
2741location into a register of @var{class2}.  The default definition returns
2742false for all inputs.
2743@end deftypefn
2744
2745@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2746Normally when @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2747allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2748If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2749defined by this macro.
2750
2751Do not define this macro if you do not define
2752@code{TARGET_SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2753@end defmac
2754
2755@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode})
2756If @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} tells the compiler to use memory
2757when moving between two particular registers of mode @var{mode},
2758this hook specifies the mode that the memory should have.
2759
2760The default depends on @code{TARGET_LRA_P}.  Without LRA, the default
2761is to use a word-sized mode for integral modes that are smaller than a
2762a word.  This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures
2763that all bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the
2764registers in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for
2765floating-point registers.
2766
2767However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2768the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2769differently than in integer registers.  On those machines, the default
2770widening will not work correctly and you must define this hook to
2771suppress that widening in some cases.  See the file @file{alpha.c} for
2772details.
2773
2774With LRA, the default is to use @var{mode} unmodified.
2775@end deftypefn
2776
2777@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SELECT_EARLY_REMAT_MODES (sbitmap @var{modes})
2778On some targets, certain modes cannot be held in registers around a
2779standard ABI call and are relatively expensive to spill to the stack.
2780The early rematerialization pass can help in such cases by aggressively
2781recomputing values after calls, so that they don't need to be spilled.
2782
2783This hook returns the set of such modes by setting the associated bits
2784in @var{modes}.  The default implementation selects no modes, which has
2785the effect of disabling the early rematerialization pass.
2786@end deftypefn
2787
2788@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2789A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2790to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2791registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2792
2793The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2794has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise.  On most machines, this
2795default should be used.  For generally register-starved machines, such as
2796i386, or machines with right register constraints, such as SH, this hook
2797can be used to avoid excessive spilling.
2798
2799This hook is also used by some of the global intra-procedural code
2800transformations to throtle code motion, to avoid increasing register
2801pressure.
2802@end deftypefn
2803
2804@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (reg_class_t @var{rclass}, machine_mode @var{mode})
2805A target hook returns the maximum number of consecutive registers
2806of class @var{rclass} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2807
2808This is closely related to the macro @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_NREGS}.
2809In fact, the value returned by @code{TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{rclass},
2810@var{mode})} target hook should be the maximum value of
2811@code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})} for all @var{regno}
2812values in the class @var{rclass}.
2813
2814This target hook helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2815in the reload pass.
2816
2817The default version of this target hook returns the size of @var{mode}
2818in words.
2819@end deftypefn
2820
2821@defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2822A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2823of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2824
2825This is closely related to the macro @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_NREGS}.  In fact,
2826the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2827should be the maximum value of @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2828@var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2829
2830This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2831in the reload pass.
2832@end defmac
2833
2834@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (machine_mode @var{from}, machine_mode @var{to}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2835This hook returns true if it is possible to bitcast values held in
2836registers of class @var{rclass} from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to}
2837and if doing so preserves the low-order bits that are common to both modes.
2838The result is only meaningful if @var{rclass} has registers that can hold
2839both @code{from} and @code{to}.  The default implementation returns true.
2840
2841As an example of when such bitcasting is invalid, loading 32-bit integer or
2842floating-point objects into floating-point registers on Alpha extends them
2843to 64 bits.  Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a
284432-bit object does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case
2845for a normal register.  Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines
2846@code{TARGET_CAN_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} to return:
2847
2848@smallexample
2849(GET_MODE_SIZE (from) == GET_MODE_SIZE (to)
2850 || !reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, rclass))
2851@end smallexample
2852
2853Even if storing from a register in mode @var{to} would be valid,
2854if both @var{from} and @code{raw_reg_mode} for @var{rclass} are wider
2855than @code{word_mode}, then we must prevent @var{to} narrowing the
2856mode.  This happens when the middle-end assumes that it can load
2857or store pieces of an @var{N}-word pseudo, and that the pseudo will
2858eventually be allocated to @var{N} @code{word_mode} hard registers.
2859Failure to prevent this kind of mode change will result in the
2860entire @code{raw_reg_mode} being modified instead of the partial
2861value that the middle-end intended.
2862@end deftypefn
2863
2864@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_IRA_CHANGE_PSEUDO_ALLOCNO_CLASS (int, @var{reg_class_t}, @var{reg_class_t})
2865A target hook which can change allocno class for given pseudo from
2866  allocno and best class calculated by IRA.
2867
2868  The default version of this target hook always returns given class.
2869@end deftypefn
2870
2871@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LRA_P (void)
2872A target hook which returns true if we use LRA instead of reload pass.    The default version of this target hook returns true.  New ports  should use LRA, and existing ports are encouraged to convert.
2873@end deftypefn
2874
2875@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_PRIORITY (int)
2876A target hook which returns the register priority number to which the  register @var{hard_regno} belongs to.  The bigger the number, the  more preferable the hard register usage (when all other conditions are  the same).  This hook can be used to prefer some hard register over  others in LRA.  For example, some x86-64 register usage needs  additional prefix which makes instructions longer.  The hook can  return lower priority number for such registers make them less favorable  and as result making the generated code smaller.    The default version of this target hook returns always zero.
2877@end deftypefn
2878
2879@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REGISTER_USAGE_LEVELING_P (void)
2880A target hook which returns true if we need register usage leveling.  That means if a few hard registers are equally good for the  assignment, we choose the least used hard register.  The register  usage leveling may be profitable for some targets.  Don't use the  usage leveling for targets with conditional execution or targets  with big register files as it hurts if-conversion and cross-jumping  optimizations.    The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2881@end deftypefn
2882
2883@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DIFFERENT_ADDR_DISPLACEMENT_P (void)
2884A target hook which returns true if an address with the same structure  can have different maximal legitimate displacement.  For example, the  displacement can depend on memory mode or on operand combinations in  the insn.    The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2885@end deftypefn
2886
2887@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_SUBSTITUTE_MEM_EQUIV_P (rtx @var{subst})
2888A target hook which returns @code{true} if @var{subst} can't
2889substitute safely pseudos with equivalent memory values during
2890register allocation.
2891The default version of this target hook returns @code{false}.
2892On most machines, this default should be used.  For generally
2893machines with non orthogonal register usage for addressing, such
2894as SH, this hook can be used to avoid excessive spilling.
2895@end deftypefn
2896
2897@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS_DISPLACEMENT (rtx *@var{offset1}, rtx *@var{offset2}, poly_int64 @var{orig_offset}, machine_mode @var{mode})
2898This hook tries to split address offset @var{orig_offset} into
2899two parts: one that should be added to the base address to create
2900a local anchor point, and an additional offset that can be applied
2901to the anchor to address a value of mode @var{mode}.  The idea is that
2902the local anchor could be shared by other accesses to nearby locations.
2903
2904The hook returns true if it succeeds, storing the offset of the
2905anchor from the base in @var{offset1} and the offset of the final address
2906from the anchor in @var{offset2}.  The default implementation returns false.
2907@end deftypefn
2908
2909@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SPILL_CLASS (reg_class_t, @var{machine_mode})
2910This hook defines a class of registers which could be used for spilling  pseudos of the given mode and class, or @code{NO_REGS} if only memory  should be used.  Not defining this hook is equivalent to returning  @code{NO_REGS} for all inputs.
2911@end deftypefn
2912
2913@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDITIONAL_ALLOCNO_CLASS_P (reg_class_t)
2914This hook should return @code{true} if given class of registers should  be an allocno class in any way.  Usually RA uses only one register  class from all classes containing the same register set.  In some  complicated cases, you need to have two or more such classes as  allocno ones for RA correct work.  Not defining this hook is  equivalent to returning @code{false} for all inputs.
2915@end deftypefn
2916
2917@deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_CSTORE_MODE (enum insn_code @var{icode})
2918This hook defines the machine mode to use for the boolean result of  conditional store patterns.  The ICODE argument is the instruction code  for the cstore being performed.  Not definiting this hook is the same  as accepting the mode encoded into operand 0 of the cstore expander  patterns.
2919@end deftypefn
2920
2921@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPUTE_PRESSURE_CLASSES (enum reg_class *@var{pressure_classes})
2922A target hook which lets a backend compute the set of pressure classes to  be used by those optimization passes which take register pressure into  account, as opposed to letting IRA compute them.  It returns the number of  register classes stored in the array @var{pressure_classes}.
2923@end deftypefn
2924
2925@node Stack and Calling
2926@section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
2927@cindex calling conventions
2928
2929@c prevent bad page break with this line
2930This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
2931
2932@menu
2933* Frame Layout::
2934* Exception Handling::
2935* Stack Checking::
2936* Frame Registers::
2937* Elimination::
2938* Stack Arguments::
2939* Register Arguments::
2940* Scalar Return::
2941* Aggregate Return::
2942* Caller Saves::
2943* Function Entry::
2944* Profiling::
2945* Tail Calls::
2946* Shrink-wrapping separate components::
2947* Stack Smashing Protection::
2948* Miscellaneous Register Hooks::
2949@end menu
2950
2951@node Frame Layout
2952@subsection Basic Stack Layout
2953@cindex stack frame layout
2954@cindex frame layout
2955
2956@c prevent bad page break with this line
2957Here is the basic stack layout.
2958
2959@defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2960Define this macro to be true if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
2961pointer to a smaller address, and false otherwise.
2962@end defmac
2963
2964@defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
2965This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
2966on the stack.  In RTL, a push operation will be
2967@code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
2968
2969The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
2970and @code{POST_INC}.  Which of these is correct depends on
2971the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
2972to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
2973space for the next item on the stack.
2974
2975The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
2976true, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
2977which is often wrong.
2978@end defmac
2979
2980@defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2981Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
2982are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
2983@end defmac
2984
2985@defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
2986Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
2987addresses on the stack.
2988@end defmac
2989
2990@deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET (void)
2991This hook returns the offset from the frame pointer to the first local
2992variable slot to be allocated.  If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, it is the
2993offset to @emph{end} of the first slot allocated, otherwise it is the
2994offset to @emph{beginning} of the first slot allocated.  The default
2995implementation returns 0.
2996@end deftypefn
2997
2998@defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
2999Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
3000The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3001
3002On ports where @code{TARGET_STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
3003is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
3004alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
3005stack alignment and do it in the backend.
3006@end defmac
3007
3008@defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
3009Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
3010outgoing arguments are placed.  If not specified, the default value of
3011zero is used.  This is the proper value for most machines.
3012
3013If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3014the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
3015@end defmac
3016
3017@defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3018Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3019address.  On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3020function.
3021
3022If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3023the first argument's address.
3024@end defmac
3025
3026@defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3027Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3028on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3029
3030The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3031length of the outgoing arguments.  The default is correct for most
3032machines.  See @file{function.c} for details.
3033@end defmac
3034
3035@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3036A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3037stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3038@code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}.  If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3039default value will be used.  Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3040elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3041@code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3042@end defmac
3043
3044@defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3045A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3046frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored.  Assume that
3047@var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3048itself.
3049
3050If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3051of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3052address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3053@end defmac
3054
3055@defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3056A C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3057setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed.  For example,
3058on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3059before we can access arbitrary stack frames.  You will seldom need to
3060define this macro.  The default is to do nothing.
3061@end defmac
3062
3063@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE (void)
3064This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3065the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3066The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3067machines.  One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3068@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3069@end deftypefn
3070
3071@defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3072A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3073address for the current frame.  @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3074of the current frame.  This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3075You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3076as the frame pointer.  Most machines do not need to define it.
3077@end defmac
3078
3079@defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3080A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3081address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3082the prologue.  @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3083frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3084@code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is nonzero.
3085
3086The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3087@var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3088determine the return address of other frames.
3089@end defmac
3090
3091@defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3092Define this macro to nonzero value if the return address of a particular
3093stack frame is accessed from the frame pointer of the previous stack
3094frame.  The zero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3095@end defmac
3096
3097@defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3098A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3099incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3100prologue.  This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3101value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3102the stack.
3103
3104You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3105debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3106
3107If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3108@code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3109@end defmac
3110
3111@defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3112A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3113number that may be used as an alternative return column.  The column
3114must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3115be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3116
3117This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3118general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3119frames.  Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3120over time.
3121@end defmac
3122
3123@defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3124A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3125number that is considered to always have the value zero.  This should
3126only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3127someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3128terminate the stack backtrace.  New ports should avoid this.
3129@end defmac
3130
3131@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC (const char *@var{label}, rtx @var{pattern}, int @var{index})
3132This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3133contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs.  The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3134info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3135@smallexample
3136(set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3137@end smallexample
3138and
3139@smallexample
3140(set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3141@end smallexample
3142to let the backend emit the call frame instructions.  @var{label} is
3143the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3144the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3145@end deftypefn
3146
3147@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_DWARF_POLY_INDETERMINATE_VALUE (unsigned int @var{i}, unsigned int *@var{factor}, int *@var{offset})
3148Express the value of @code{poly_int} indeterminate @var{i} as a DWARF
3149expression, with @var{i} counting from 1.  Return the number of a DWARF
3150register @var{R} and set @samp{*@var{factor}} and @samp{*@var{offset}} such
3151that the value of the indeterminate is:
3152@smallexample
3153value_of(@var{R}) / @var{factor} - @var{offset}
3154@end smallexample
3155
3156A target only needs to define this hook if it sets
3157@samp{NUM_POLY_INT_COEFFS} to a value greater than 1.
3158@end deftypefn
3159
3160@defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3161A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3162from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3163frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue.  The top of
3164the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3165previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3166
3167You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3168debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3169@end defmac
3170
3171@defmac DEFAULT_INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3172Like @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}, but must be the same for all
3173functions of the same ABI, and when using GAS @code{.cfi_*} directives
3174must also agree with the default CFI GAS emits.  Define this macro
3175only if @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET} can have different values
3176between different functions of the same ABI or when
3177@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET} does not agree with GAS default CFI.
3178@end defmac
3179
3180@defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3181A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3182from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).  The
3183final value should coincide with that calculated by
3184@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.  Which is unfortunately not usable
3185during virtual register instantiation.
3186
3187The default value for this macro is
3188@code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3189which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3190immediately before the stack frame.  Note that this is not the case on
3191some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3192and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3193
3194You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3195want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3196DWARF 2.
3197@end defmac
3198
3199@defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3200If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3201in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3202The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3203@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3204
3205Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3206via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3207variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible.  If this macro is
3208defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3209based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer.  Only one
3210of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3211should be defined.
3212@end defmac
3213
3214@defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3215If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3216in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3217in DWARF 2 debug information.  The default is zero.  A different value
3218may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3219@end defmac
3220
3221@node Exception Handling
3222@subsection Exception Handling Support
3223@cindex exception handling
3224
3225@defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3226A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3227data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3228@var{N} registers are usable.
3229
3230The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3231handlers via a set of agreed upon registers.  Ideally these registers
3232should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3233but may negatively impact code size.  The target must support at least
32342 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3235
3236You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3237handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3238@end defmac
3239
3240@defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3241A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3242to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3243This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3244It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3245
3246Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3247untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3248
3249Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3250by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3251this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3252stack location to be restored in place.  Otherwise, you must define
3253this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3254that provided by DWARF 2.
3255@end defmac
3256
3257@defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3258A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3259to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3260return.  It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3261
3262Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3263return address is stored.  For targets that return by popping an
3264address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3265the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3266frame.  If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3267been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3268target call frame.
3269
3270Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3271address calculable during initial code generation.  In that case
3272the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3273
3274If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3275define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3276@end defmac
3277
3278@defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3279If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3280to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3281exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3282using it to return to the exception handler.
3283@end defmac
3284
3285@defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3286This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3287handling sections.  If at all possible, this should be defined such
3288that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3289and so may be read-only.
3290
3291@var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3292@var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3293The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3294as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3295
3296If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3297represented directly.
3298@end defmac
3299
3300@defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3301This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3302to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3303Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3304be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3305
3306This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3307handled.  @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3308of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3309to be emitted.
3310@end defmac
3311
3312@defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3313This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3314code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3315available.  The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3316through signal frames.
3317
3318This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3319@file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3320@file{unwind-ia64.c}.  @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3321@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}.  Examine @code{context->ra}
3322for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3323the stack pointer value.  If the frame can be decoded, the register
3324save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3325evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}.  If the frame cannot be decoded,
3326the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3327
3328For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3329@code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3330@end defmac
3331
3332@defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3333This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3334call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3335usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3336
3337This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in libgcc's
3338@file{unwind-ia64.c}.  @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3339@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}.  Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3340for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive.  If the
3341@code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3342be updated in @var{fs}.
3343@end defmac
3344
3345@defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3346A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3347info to be given comdat linkage.  Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3348linkage is necessary.  The default is @code{0}.
3349@end defmac
3350
3351@node Stack Checking
3352@subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3353
3354GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3355stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3356three ways:
3357
3358@enumerate
3359@item
3360If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3361will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3362at appropriate places in the configuration files.  GCC will not do
3363other special processing.
3364
3365@item
3366If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3367@code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3368that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3369static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3370in the configuration files.  GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3371stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3372approach below.
3373
3374@item
3375If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3376``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3377@end enumerate
3378
3379If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3380GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3381@option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3382dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3383
3384@defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3385A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3386machine-dependent manner.  You should define this macro if stack checking
3387is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3388checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach.  The default
3389value of this macro is zero.
3390@end defmac
3391
3392@defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3393A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3394in a machine-dependent manner.  You should define this macro if you would
3395like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3396approach.  The default value of this macro is zero.
3397@end defmac
3398
3399@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3400An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3401instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer.  You will normally
3402define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3403the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area.  The default value
3404of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3405@end defmac
3406
3407@defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3408An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3409when doing probes.  This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3410contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3411thread at any point in time.  In this situation an alternate signal stack
3412is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow.  The
3413default value of this macro is zero.
3414@end defmac
3415
3416@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3417The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3418languages where such a recovery is supported.  The default value of 4KB/8KB
3419with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
34208KB/12KB with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for most
3421architectures and operating systems.
3422@end defmac
3423
3424The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3425nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3426in the opposite case.
3427
3428@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3429The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes.  GCC will generate probe
3430instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3431stack are available.  If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3432checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning.  The
3433default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3434systems.  You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3435@end defmac
3436
3437@defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3438GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message.  It
3439represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3440space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3441You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3442use the default of four words.
3443@end defmac
3444
3445@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3446The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3447fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3448@option{-fstack-check}.
3449GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3450normally not need to override that default.
3451@end defmac
3452
3453@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STACK_CLASH_PROTECTION_FINAL_DYNAMIC_PROBE (rtx @var{residual})
3454Some targets make optimistic assumptions about the state of stack probing when they emit their prologues.  On such targets a probe into the end of any dynamically allocated space is likely required for safety against stack clash style attacks.  Define this variable to return nonzero if such a probe is required or zero otherwise.  You need not define this macro if it would always have the value zero.
3455@end deftypefn
3456
3457@need 2000
3458@node Frame Registers
3459@subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3460
3461@c prevent bad page break with this line
3462This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3463
3464@defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3465The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3466fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}.  On most machines,
3467the hardware determines which register this is.
3468@end defmac
3469
3470@defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3471The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3472access automatic variables in the stack frame.  On some machines, the
3473hardware determines which register this is.  On other machines, you can
3474choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3475@end defmac
3476
3477@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3478On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3479offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3480allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3481between these two locations).  On those machines, define
3482@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3483be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3484@code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3485used for the frame pointer.
3486
3487You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3488is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3489the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3490completed.  When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3491definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3492@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3493or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3494
3495Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3496@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3497@end defmac
3498
3499@defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3500The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3501the function's argument list.  On some machines, this is the same as the
3502frame pointer register.  On some machines, the hardware determines which
3503register this is.  On other machines, you can choose any register you
3504wish for this purpose.  If this is not the same register as the frame
3505pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3506@code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3507(@pxref{Elimination}).
3508@end defmac
3509
3510@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3511Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3512@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3513the same.  The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3514== FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3515definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3516@end defmac
3517
3518@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3519Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3520@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3521same.  The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3522ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3523definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3524@end defmac
3525
3526@defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3527The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3528access the current function's return address from the stack.  On some
3529machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3530pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer.  This register can be defined
3531to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3532@code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3533
3534Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3535address from the stack.
3536@end defmac
3537
3538@defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3539@defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3540Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer.  If
3541register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3542function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3543number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}.  If
3544these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3545not be defined.
3546
3547The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3548
3549If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3550defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3551@end defmac
3552
3553@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN (const_tree @var{fndecl_or_type}, bool @var{incoming_p})
3554This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3555targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3556nested functions.  This may be required if the target has function
3557attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3558those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3559
3560The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3561
3562If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3563provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3564Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3565from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3566will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3567@findex stack_pointer_rtx
3568@findex frame_pointer_rtx
3569@findex arg_pointer_rtx
3570The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3571@code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3572to refer to those items.
3573@end deftypefn
3574
3575@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3576This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3577saved in a call frame.  This is used to size data structures used in
3578DWARF2 exception handling.
3579
3580Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3581exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3582extensions.  In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3583in the number of hard registers.  Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3584used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3585routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3586registers that are not call-saved.
3587
3588If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3589@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3590@end defmac
3591
3592@defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3593
3594This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3595for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3596
3597If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3598@code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3599@end defmac
3600
3601@defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3602
3603Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3604is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3605Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3606column number to use instead.
3607@end defmac
3608
3609@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3610
3611Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3612used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3613debug info sections.  Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3614should return the .eh_frame register number.  The default is
3615@code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3616
3617@end defmac
3618
3619@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3620
3621Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3622that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3623should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3624.eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero).  The default is to
3625return @code{@var{regno}}.
3626
3627@end defmac
3628
3629@defmac REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3630
3631Define this macro if the target stores register values as
3632@code{_Unwind_Word} type in unwind context.  It should be defined if
3633target register size is larger than the size of @code{void *}.  The
3634default is to store register values as @code{void *} type.
3635
3636@end defmac
3637
3638@defmac ASSUME_EXTENDED_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3639
3640Define this macro to be 1 if the target always uses extended unwind
3641context with version, args_size and by_value fields.  If it is undefined,
3642it will be defined to 1 when @code{REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT} is
3643defined and 0 otherwise.
3644
3645@end defmac
3646
3647@defmac DWARF_LAZY_REGISTER_VALUE (@var{regno}, @var{value})
3648Define this macro if the target has pseudo DWARF registers whose
3649values need to be computed lazily on demand by the unwinder (such as when
3650referenced in a CFA expression).  The macro returns true if @var{regno}
3651is such a register and stores its value in @samp{*@var{value}} if so.
3652@end defmac
3653
3654@node Elimination
3655@subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3656
3657@c prevent bad page break with this line
3658This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3659
3660@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED (void)
3661This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3662a frame pointer.  This target hook is called in the reload pass.  If its return
3663value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3664
3665This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3666according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3667constant @code{true} suffices.  Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3668to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3669Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3670pointer.
3671
3672In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3673without a frame pointer.  The compiler recognizes those cases and
3674automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3675@code{targetm.frame_pointer_required} returns.  You don't need to worry about
3676them.
3677
3678In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3679register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3680fixed register.  See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3681
3682Default return value is @code{false}.
3683@end deftypefn
3684
3685@defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3686This macro specifies a table of register pairs used to eliminate
3687unneeded registers that point into the stack frame.
3688
3689The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3690of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3691
3692On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3693the compilation is completed.  In such a case, a separate hard register
3694must be used for the argument pointer.  This register can be eliminated by
3695replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3696depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3697
3698In this case, you might specify:
3699@smallexample
3700#define ELIMINABLE_REGS  \
3701@{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3702 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3703 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3704@end smallexample
3705
3706Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3707specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3708@end defmac
3709
3710@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE (const int @var{from_reg}, const int @var{to_reg})
3711This target hook should return @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3712try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3713@var{to_reg}.  This target hook will usually be @code{true}, since most of the
3714cases preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3715knows about.
3716
3717Default return value is @code{true}.
3718@end deftypefn
3719
3720@defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3721This macro returns the initial difference between the specified pair
3722of registers.  The value would be computed from information
3723such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3724registers @code{df_regs_ever_live_p} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3725@end defmac
3726
3727@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_COMPUTE_FRAME_LAYOUT (void)
3728This target hook is called once each time the frame layout needs to be
3729recalculated.  The calculations can be cached by the target and can then
3730be used by @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET} instead of re-computing the
3731layout on every invocation of that hook.  This is particularly useful
3732for targets that have an expensive frame layout function.  Implementing
3733this callback is optional.
3734@end deftypefn
3735
3736@node Stack Arguments
3737@subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3738@cindex arguments on stack
3739@cindex stack arguments
3740
3741The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3742on the stack.  See the following section for other macros that
3743control passing certain arguments in registers.
3744
3745@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES (const_tree @var{fntype})
3746This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3747prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3748passed as an @code{int}.  In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3749cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3750The default is to not promote prototypes.
3751@end deftypefn
3752
3753@defmac PUSH_ARGS
3754A C expression.  If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3755outgoing arguments.
3756If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3757That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3758allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3759it.  When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3760@end defmac
3761
3762@defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3763A C expression.  If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3764last to first, rather than from first to last.  If this macro is not
3765defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3766and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3767@end defmac
3768
3769@defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3770A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3771stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3772
3773On some machines, the definition
3774
3775@smallexample
3776#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3777@end smallexample
3778
3779@noindent
3780will suffice.  But on other machines, instructions that appear
3781to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3782alignment.  Then the definition should be
3783
3784@smallexample
3785#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3786@end smallexample
3787
3788If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
3789@end defmac
3790
3791@findex outgoing_args_size
3792@findex crtl->outgoing_args_size
3793@defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3794A C expression.  If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3795will be computed and placed into
3796@code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}.  No space will be pushed
3797onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3798increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3799
3800Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3801is not proper.
3802@end defmac
3803
3804@defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3805Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3806allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3807registers.
3808
3809The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3810arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3811which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3812The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3813of the function.
3814
3815This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3816machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3817which.
3818@end defmac
3819@c above is overfull.  not sure what to do.  --mew 5feb93  did
3820@c something, not sure if it looks good.  --mew 10feb93
3821
3822@defmac INCOMING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3823Like @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, but for incoming register arguments.
3824Define this macro if space guaranteed when compiling a function body
3825is different to space required when making a call, a situation that
3826can arise with K&R style function definitions.
3827@end defmac
3828
3829@defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3830Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3831caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3832when calling a function of @var{fntype}.  @var{fntype} may be NULL
3833if the function called is a library function.
3834
3835If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3836whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3837@code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}.
3838@end defmac
3839
3840@defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3841Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3842stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3843@c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3844@c overfull.. not as specific, tho.  --mew 5feb93
3845
3846Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3847stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area.  Defining this macro
3848suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3849stack in its natural location.
3850@end defmac
3851
3852@deftypefn {Target Hook} poly_int64 TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS (tree @var{fundecl}, tree @var{funtype}, poly_int64 @var{size})
3853This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3854a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3855and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
3856
3857@var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3858the function in question.  Normally it is a node of type
3859@code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3860From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3861
3862@var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3863describes the function in question.  Normally it is a node of type
3864@code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3865From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3866arguments (if known).
3867
3868When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3869will contain an identifier node for the library function.  Thus, if
3870you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3871by their names.  Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3872a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3873in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3874
3875@var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
3876stack.  If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3877argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3878
3879On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
3880of this macro is @var{size}.  On the 68000, using the standard
3881calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3882the macro is always 0 in this case.  But an alternative calling
3883convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3884arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3885nothing (the caller pops all).  When this convention is in use,
3886@var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3887number of arguments.
3888@end deftypefn
3889
3890@defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3891A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3892pops off the stack.  It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3893when compiling a function call.
3894
3895@var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3896have been accumulated.
3897
3898On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3899that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3900that have been passed to the function.  Since this is a property of the
3901call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3902appropriate.
3903@end defmac
3904
3905@node Register Arguments
3906@subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3907@cindex arguments in registers
3908@cindex registers arguments
3909
3910This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3911types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3912the stack.
3913
3914@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
3915Return an RTX indicating whether a function argument is passed in a
3916register and if so, which register.
3917
3918The arguments are @var{ca}, which summarizes all the previous
3919arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
3920the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
3921(which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
3922which is @code{true} for an ordinary argument and @code{false} for
3923nameless arguments that correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called
3924function's prototype.  @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a
3925syntax error has previously occurred.
3926
3927The return value is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3928register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the argument
3929on the stack.
3930
3931The return value can be a @code{const_int} which means argument is
3932passed in a target specific slot with specified number.  Target hooks
3933should be used to store or load argument in such case.  See
3934@code{TARGET_STORE_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG} and @code{TARGET_LOAD_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG}
3935for more information.
3936
3937The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@.  This is
3938used when an argument is passed in multiple locations.  The mode of the
3939@code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument.  The
3940@code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
3941describes where part of the argument is passed.  In each
3942@code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3943register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
3944register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is.  The
3945second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
3946the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
3947As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
3948RTX may have a first operand of zero.  This indicates that the entire
3949argument is also stored on the stack.
3950
3951The last time this hook is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
3952VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
3953pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
3954
3955@cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
3956The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a
3957machine where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to
3958cause nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead.  This is
3959done by making @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever
3960@var{named} is @code{false}.
3961
3962@cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
3963@cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
3964You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
3965in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
3966type that must be passed in the stack.  If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
3967is not defined and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
3968argument, the compiler will abort.  If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
3969defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
3970a register.
3971@end deftypefn
3972
3973@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
3974This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
3975solely in registers.  The file @file{expr.h} defines a
3976definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
3977documentation.
3978@end deftypefn
3979
3980@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
3981Define this hook if the caller and callee on the target have different
3982views of where arguments are passed.  Also define this hook if there are
3983functions that are never directly called, but are invoked by the hardware
3984and which have nonstandard calling conventions.
3985
3986In this case @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in
3987which the caller passes the value, and
3988@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should be defined in a similar
3989fashion to tell the function being called where the arguments will
3990arrive.
3991
3992@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} can also return arbitrary address
3993computation using hard register, which can be forced into a register,
3994so that it can be used to pass special arguments.
3995
3996If @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined,
3997@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} serves both purposes.
3998@end deftypefn
3999
4000@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_PSEUDO_PIC_REG (void)
4001This hook should return 1 in case pseudo register should be created
4002for pic_offset_table_rtx during function expand.
4003@end deftypefn
4004
4005@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_PIC_REG (void)
4006Perform a target dependent initialization of pic_offset_table_rtx.
4007This hook is called at the start of register allocation.
4008@end deftypefn
4009
4010@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4011This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
4012argument that must be put in registers.  The value must be zero for
4013arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
4014pushed on the stack.
4015
4016On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
4017registers and partially in memory.  On these machines, typically the
4018first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
4019on the stack.  If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
4020structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
4021in registers and the rest must be pushed.  This macro tells the
4022compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
4023
4024@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
4025register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
4026@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
4027@end deftypefn
4028
4029@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4030This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
4031position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference.  This
4032predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
4033passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
4034
4035If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
4036pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
4037The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
4038to that type.
4039@end deftypefn
4040
4041@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4042The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
4043known to be passed by reference.  The hook should return true if the
4044function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4045by the caller.
4046
4047For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
4048determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4049not be generated.
4050
4051The default version of this hook always returns false.
4052@end deftypefn
4053
4054@defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
4055A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument
4056of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values.  For some
4057target machines, the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number
4058of bytes of argument so far.
4059
4060There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4061arguments that have been passed on the stack.  The compiler has other
4062variables to keep track of that.  For target machines on which all
4063arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4064@code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4065should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4066@end defmac
4067
4068@defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4069If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4070function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4071created.  The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4072reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4073If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4074@var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4075@end defmac
4076
4077@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4078A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4079@var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list.  The
4080variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.  The value of @var{fntype}
4081is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4082the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4083For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4084declaration node of the function.  @var{fndecl} is also set when
4085@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4086being compiled.  @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4087arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4088parameter, when making a call.  When processing incoming arguments,
4089@var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4090
4091When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4092@var{libname} identifies which one.  It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4093contains the name of the function, as a string.  @var{libname} is 0 when
4094an ordinary C function call is being processed.  Thus, each time this
4095macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4096never both of them at once.
4097@end defmac
4098
4099@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4100Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4101it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4102@code{NULL}.  @var{indirect} would always be zero, too.  If this macro
4103is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
41040)} is used instead.
4105@end defmac
4106
4107@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4108Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4109finding the arguments for the function being compiled.  If this macro is
4110undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4111
4112The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4113with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@.  The
4114argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4115@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4116@c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4117@c --mew 5feb93   i switched the order of the sentences.  --mew 10feb93
4118@end defmac
4119
4120@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4121This hook updates the summarizer variable pointed to by @var{ca} to
4122advance past an argument in the argument list.  The values @var{mode},
4123@var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument.  Once this is done,
4124the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing the @emph{following}
4125argument with @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
4126
4127This hook need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
4128on the stack.  The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4129used for arguments without any special help.
4130@end deftypefn
4131
4132@deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4133This hook returns the number of bytes to add to the offset of an
4134argument of type @var{type} and mode @var{mode} when passed in memory.
4135This is needed for the SPU, which passes @code{char} and @code{short}
4136arguments in the preferred slot that is in the middle of the quad word
4137instead of starting at the top.  The default implementation returns 0.
4138@end deftypefn
4139
4140@deftypefn {Target Hook} pad_direction TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4141This hook determines whether, and in which direction, to pad out
4142an argument of mode @var{mode} and type @var{type}.  It returns
4143@code{PAD_UPWARD} to insert padding above the argument, @code{PAD_DOWNWARD}
4144to insert padding below the argument, or @code{PAD_NONE} to inhibit padding.
4145
4146The @emph{amount} of padding is not controlled by this hook, but by
4147@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY}.  It is always just enough
4148to reach the next multiple of that boundary.
4149
4150This hook has a default definition that is right for most systems.
4151For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward.  For
4152big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4153constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4154@end deftypefn
4155
4156@defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4157If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4158implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4159next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4160controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.  If this macro is not defined, all such
4161arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4162@end defmac
4163
4164@defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4165Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4166memory.  @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element.  Defining this
4167macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4168machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl.  In particular,
4169@code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4170registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register;  For example,
4171a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4172required.
4173@end defmac
4174
4175@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4176This hook returns the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument
4177with the specified mode and type.  The default hook returns
4178@code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.
4179@end deftypefn
4180
4181@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4182Normally, the size of an argument is rounded up to @code{PARM_BOUNDARY},
4183which is the default value for this hook.  You can define this hook to
4184return a different value if an argument size must be rounded to a larger
4185value.
4186@end deftypefn
4187
4188@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4189A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4190register in which function arguments are sometimes passed.  This does
4191@emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4192the structure-value address.  On many machines, no registers can be
4193used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4194stack.
4195@end defmac
4196
4197@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG (const_tree @var{type})
4198This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4199as two scalar parameters.  By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4200arguments into the target's word size.  Some ABIs require complex arguments
4201to be split and treated as their individual components.  For example, on
4202AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4203registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4204point register.
4205
4206The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4207false.
4208@end deftypefn
4209
4210@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST (void)
4211This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4212The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4213@end deftypefn
4214
4215@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P (int @var{idx}, const char **@var{pname}, tree *@var{ptree})
4216This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4217to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4218variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
4219to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
4220variable.
4221The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
4222this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4223internal type.
4224If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4225Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4226macro to iterate through all types.
4227@end deftypefn
4228
4229@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST (tree @var{fndecl})
4230This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4231@var{fndecl}.
4232The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4233@end deftypefn
4234
4235@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE (tree @var{type})
4236This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4237type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4238@code{NULL_TREE}.
4239@end deftypefn
4240
4241@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR (tree @var{valist}, tree @var{type}, gimple_seq *@var{pre_p}, gimple_seq *@var{post_p})
4242This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4243@code{VA_ARG_EXPR}.  The first two parameters correspond to the
4244arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4245@code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4246@end deftypefn
4247
4248@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE (scalar_int_mode @var{mode})
4249Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4250with machine mode @var{mode}.  The default version of this
4251hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4252@end deftypefn
4253
4254@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REF_MAY_ALIAS_ERRNO (struct ao_ref *@var{ref})
4255Define this to return nonzero if the memory reference @var{ref}  may alias with the system C library errno location.  The default  version of this hook assumes the system C library errno location  is either a declaration of type int or accessed by dereferencing  a pointer to int.
4256@end deftypefn
4257
4258@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (scalar_mode @var{mode})
4259Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4260insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}.  For a scalar mode to be
4261considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4262must work.
4263
4264The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4265required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4266Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4267code in @file{optabs.c}.
4268@end deftypefn
4269
4270@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
4271Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4272insns involving vector mode @var{mode}.  At the very least, it
4273must have move patterns for this mode.
4274@end deftypefn
4275
4276@deftypefn {Target Hook} opt_machine_mode TARGET_ARRAY_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{nelems})
4277Return the mode that GCC should use for an array that has
4278@var{nelems} elements, with each element having mode @var{mode}.
4279Return no mode if the target has no special requirements.  In the
4280latter case, GCC looks for an integer mode of the appropriate size
4281if available and uses BLKmode otherwise.  Usually the search for the
4282integer mode is limited to @code{MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE}, but the
4283@code{TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P} hook allows a larger mode to be
4284used in specific cases.
4285
4286The main use of this hook is to specify that an array of vectors should
4287also have a vector mode.  The default implementation returns no mode.
4288@end deftypefn
4289
4290@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{nelems})
4291Return true if GCC should try to use a scalar mode to store an array
4292of @var{nelems} elements, given that each element has mode @var{mode}.
4293Returning true here overrides the usual @code{MAX_FIXED_MODE} limit
4294and allows GCC to use any defined integer mode.
4295
4296One use of this hook is to support vector load and store operations
4297that operate on several homogeneous vectors.  For example, ARM NEON
4298has operations like:
4299
4300@smallexample
4301int8x8x3_t vld3_s8 (const int8_t *)
4302@end smallexample
4303
4304where the return type is defined as:
4305
4306@smallexample
4307typedef struct int8x8x3_t
4308@{
4309  int8x8_t val[3];
4310@} int8x8x3_t;
4311@end smallexample
4312
4313If this hook allows @code{val} to have a scalar mode, then
4314@code{int8x8x3_t} can have the same mode.  GCC can then store
4315@code{int8x8x3_t}s in registers rather than forcing them onto the stack.
4316@end deftypefn
4317
4318@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBGCC_FLOATING_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (scalar_float_mode @var{mode})
4319Define this to return nonzero if libgcc provides support for the
4320floating-point mode @var{mode}, which is known to pass
4321@code{TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P}.  The default version of this
4322hook returns true for all of @code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode},
4323@code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode}, if such modes exist.
4324@end deftypefn
4325
4326@deftypefn {Target Hook} opt_scalar_float_mode TARGET_FLOATN_MODE (int @var{n}, bool @var{extended})
4327Define this to return the machine mode to use for the type
4328@code{_Float@var{n}}, if @var{extended} is false, or the type
4329@code{_Float@var{n}x}, if @var{extended} is true.  If such a type is not
4330supported, return @code{opt_scalar_float_mode ()}.  The default version of
4331this hook returns @code{SFmode} for @code{_Float32}, @code{DFmode} for
4332@code{_Float64} and @code{_Float32x} and @code{TFmode} for
4333@code{_Float128}, if those modes exist and satisfy the requirements for
4334those types and pass @code{TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P} and
4335@code{TARGET_LIBGCC_FLOATING_MODE_SUPPORTED_P}; for @code{_Float64x}, it
4336returns the first of @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} that exists and
4337satisfies the same requirements; for other types, it returns
4338@code{opt_scalar_float_mode ()}.  The hook is only called for values
4339of @var{n} and @var{extended} that are valid according to
4340ISO/IEC TS 18661-3:2015; that is, @var{n} is one of 32, 64, 128, or,
4341if @var{extended} is false, 16 or greater than 128 and a multiple of 32.
4342@end deftypefn
4343
4344@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FLOATN_BUILTIN_P (int @var{func})
4345Define this to return true if the @code{_Float@var{n}} and
4346@code{_Float@var{n}x} built-in functions should implicitly enable the
4347built-in function without the @code{__builtin_} prefix in addition to the
4348normal built-in function with the @code{__builtin_} prefix.  The default is
4349to only enable built-in functions without the @code{__builtin_} prefix for
4350the GNU C langauge.  In strict ANSI/ISO mode, the built-in function without
4351the @code{__builtin_} prefix is not enabled.  The argument @code{FUNC} is the
4352@code{enum built_in_function} id of the function to be enabled.
4353@end deftypefn
4354
4355@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
4356Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4357small register classes.  If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4358@var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4359in @var{mode}.  The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4360In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4361for any mode.
4362
4363On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4364insns.  Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4365to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4366if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4367insn.
4368
4369Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4370in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4371the instruction are already known.  And for some machines, register
4372classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4373registers.  For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4374registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4375SSE registers for floating point operations.  On such targets, a good
4376strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4377machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4378
4379The default version of this hook returns false for any mode.  It is always
4380safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value.  But if you
4381unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4382that can be performed in some cases.  If you do not define this hook
4383to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4384of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4385@end deftypefn
4386
4387@node Scalar Return
4388@subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4389@cindex return values in registers
4390@cindex values, returned by functions
4391@cindex scalars, returned as values
4392
4393This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4394values---values that can fit in registers.
4395
4396@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
4397
4398Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4399returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4400representing a data type.  @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4401representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4402function being called.  If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4403compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4404Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4405a function returns a value.
4406
4407On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4408(Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4409place regardless of mode.)  The value of the expression is usually a
4410@code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4411The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
4412multiple places.  See @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
4413@code{parallel} form.   Note that the callee will populate every
4414location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4415the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4416that element as the canonical location and ignore the others.  The m68k
4417port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4418@samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4419
4420If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4421the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4422@var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4423
4424If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4425node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4426pointer.  This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4427convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4428known.
4429
4430Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4431which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4432the caller sees the value.  For such machines, you should return
4433different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4434
4435@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4436aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way.  See
4437@code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4438@end deftypefn
4439
4440@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4441This macro has been deprecated.  Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4442a new target instead.
4443@end defmac
4444
4445@defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4446A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4447function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4448
4449Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4450support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4451specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4452compiled.
4453@end defmac
4454
4455@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{fun})
4456Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
4457function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
4458
4459The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
4460library function is given by @var{fun}.  The hook should return an RTX
4461representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4462
4463If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4464@end deftypefn
4465
4466@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4467A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4468register in which the values of called function may come back.
4469
4470A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4471second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4472recognized by this macro.  So for most machines, this definition
4473suffices:
4474
4475@smallexample
4476#define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4477@end smallexample
4478
4479If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4480function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4481should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4482
4483This macro has been deprecated.  Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4484for a new target instead.
4485@end defmac
4486
4487@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (const unsigned int @var{regno})
4488A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4489register in which the values of called function may come back.
4490
4491A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4492second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4493recognized by this target hook.
4494
4495If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4496function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4497should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4498
4499If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4500@end deftypefn
4501
4502@defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4503Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4504need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4505saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4506@end defmac
4507
4508@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OMIT_STRUCT_RETURN_REG
4509Normally, when a function returns a structure by memory, the address
4510is passed as an invisible pointer argument, but the compiler also
4511arranges to return the address from the function like it would a normal
4512pointer return value.  Define this to true if that behavior is
4513undesirable on your target.
4514@end deftypevr
4515
4516@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB (const_tree @var{type})
4517This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4518at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4519padded at the least significant end).  You can assume that @var{type}
4520is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4521
4522Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4523be able to hold the complete return value.  For example, if a 1-, 2-
4524or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
45254-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4526@code{SImode} rtx.
4527@end deftypefn
4528
4529@node Aggregate Return
4530@subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4531@cindex aggregates as return values
4532@cindex large return values
4533@cindex returning aggregate values
4534@cindex structure value address
4535
4536When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4537cases), the value is not returned according to
4538@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}).  Instead, the
4539caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4540should be stored.  This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4541address}.
4542
4543This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4544memory.
4545
4546@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY (const_tree @var{type}, const_tree @var{fntype})
4547This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4548function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4549Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4550will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4551libcalls.
4552
4553Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4554by this function.  Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4555takes effect regardless of this macro.  On most systems, it is
4556possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4557definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4558values, and 0 otherwise.
4559
4560Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4561be returned in memory.  You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4562to indicate this.
4563@end deftypefn
4564
4565@defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4566Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4567in memory.  Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4568only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4569If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4570and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4571target hook.
4572
4573If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4574@end defmac
4575
4576@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{incoming})
4577This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4578address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4579passed as an ``invisible'' first argument.  Note that @var{fndecl} may
4580be @code{NULL}, for libcalls.  You do not need to define this target
4581hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4582argument.
4583
4584On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4585is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4586caller put it.  This can be due to register windows, or it could
4587be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4588@var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4589the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4590the caller.
4591
4592If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4593stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4594@var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4595structure value address at the beginning of a function.  If you need
4596to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4597@end deftypefn
4598
4599@defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4600Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4601for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4602the address of a static variable containing the value.
4603
4604Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4605pass an address to the subroutine.
4606
4607This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4608nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4609@end defmac
4610
4611@deftypefn {Target Hook} fixed_size_mode TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE (int @var{regno})
4612This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw return registers in @code{__builtin_return}.  Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4613@end deftypefn
4614
4615@deftypefn {Target Hook} fixed_size_mode TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE (int @var{regno})
4616This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw argument registers in @code{__builtin_apply_args}.  Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4617@end deftypefn
4618
4619@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMPTY_RECORD_P (const_tree @var{type})
4620This target hook returns true if the type is an empty record.  The default
4621is to return @code{false}.
4622@end deftypefn
4623
4624@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_WARN_PARAMETER_PASSING_ABI (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, tree @var{type})
4625This target hook warns about the change in empty class parameter passing
4626ABI.
4627@end deftypefn
4628
4629@node Caller Saves
4630@subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4631
4632If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls.  This
4633makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4634must live across calls.
4635
4636@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4637A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4638of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}.  If
4639@var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4640returned.  For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4641will select the smallest suitable mode.
4642@end defmac
4643
4644@node Function Entry
4645@subsection Function Entry and Exit
4646@cindex function entry and exit
4647@cindex prologue
4648@cindex epilogue
4649
4650This section describes the macros that output function entry
4651(@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4652
4653@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_PRINT_PATCHABLE_FUNCTION_ENTRY (FILE *@var{file}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{patch_area_size}, bool @var{record_p})
4654Generate a patchable area at the function start, consisting of
4655@var{patch_area_size} NOP instructions.  If the target supports named
4656sections and if @var{record_p} is true, insert a pointer to the current
4657location in the table of patchable functions.  The default implementation
4658of the hook places the table of pointers in the special section named
4659@code{__patchable_function_entries}.
4660@end deftypefn
4661
4662@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4663If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4664function.  The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4665initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4666saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4667local variables.  @var{file} is a stdio stream to which the assembler
4668code should be output.
4669
4670The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4671macro.  That has already been done when the macro is run.
4672
4673@findex regs_ever_live
4674To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4675@code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4676@var{r} is used anywhere within the function.  This implies the function
4677prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4678call-used registers.  (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4679@code{regs_ever_live}.)
4680
4681On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4682not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4683they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4684appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4685registers are used in the function.
4686
4687@findex frame_pointer_needed
4688On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4689function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4690pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise.  To determine whether a
4691frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4692@code{frame_pointer_needed}.  The variable's value will be 1 at run
4693time in a function that needs a frame pointer.  @xref{Elimination}.
4694
4695The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4696required for the function.  This stack space consists of the regions
4697listed below.  In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4698order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4699stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4700the highest address if it is not defined).  You can use a different order
4701for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4702compatibility reasons.  Except in cases where required by standard
4703or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4704need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4705@end deftypefn
4706
4707@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4708If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4709prologue.  This should be used when the function prologue is being
4710emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4711emitted.  @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4712@end deftypefn
4713
4714@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4715If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4716epilogue.  This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4717emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4718emitted.  @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4719@end deftypefn
4720
4721@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4722If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4723function.  The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4724registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4725called, and returning control to the caller.  This macro takes the
4726same argument as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4727registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4728@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4729
4730On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4731of returning from the function.  On these machines, give that
4732instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4733@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4734
4735Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4736@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used.  If you want the target
4737switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4738define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4739target switches appropriately.  If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4740condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4741
4742On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4743function exit code must vary accordingly.  Sometimes the code for these
4744two cases is completely different.  To determine whether a frame pointer
4745is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4746@code{frame_pointer_needed}.  The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4747a function that needs a frame pointer.
4748
4749Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4750@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4751The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4752function.  @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4753
4754On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4755others leave that for the caller to do.  For example, the 68020 when
4756given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4757number of arguments.
4758
4759@findex pops_args
4760@findex crtl->args.pops_args
4761Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4762functions pop their own arguments.  @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4763needs to know what was decided.  The number of bytes of the current
4764function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4765@code{crtl->args.pops_args}.  @xref{Scalar Return}.
4766@end deftypefn
4767
4768@itemize @bullet
4769@item
4770@findex pretend_args_size
4771@findex crtl->args.pretend_args_size
4772A region of @code{crtl->args.pretend_args_size} bytes of
4773uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4774stack.  (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4775if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4776arguments.  But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4777yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.)  This
4778region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4779registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4780features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4781
4782@item
4783An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4784The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4785the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4786machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4787in the function.  Machines with register windows often do not require
4788a save area.
4789
4790@item
4791A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4792boundary, to contain the local variables of the function.  On some machines,
4793this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4794save area closer to the top of the stack.
4795
4796@item
4797@cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4798Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4799@code{crtl->outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4800argument lists of the function.  @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4801@end itemize
4802
4803@defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4804Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4805instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4806pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4807adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function.  The
4808default is 0.
4809
4810Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4811frame pointers are maintained.  It is never safe to delete a final
4812stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4813compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4814@end defmac
4815
4816@defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4817Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4818used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern.  The stack and frame
4819pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4820@end defmac
4821
4822@defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4823Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4824used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4825on entry to an exception edge.
4826@end defmac
4827
4828@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, tree @var{function})
4829A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4830function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4831inheritance.  The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4832adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4833the real function.
4834
4835First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4836contains the incoming first argument.  Assume that this argument
4837contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4838in C++.  This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4839e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc.  The addition must preserve the values of
4840all other incoming arguments.
4841
4842Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4843made after adding @code{delta}.  In particular, if @var{p} is the
4844adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4845
4846@smallexample
4847p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4848@end smallexample
4849
4850After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4851@code{FUNCTION_DECL}.  This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4852not touch the return address.  Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4853return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4854
4855The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4856the adjusted first argument.  This macro is responsible for emitting all
4857of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4858and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4859
4860The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant.  (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4861have already been extracted from it.)  It might possibly be useful on
4862some targets, but probably not.
4863
4864If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4865front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4866@var{function} instead of jumping to it.  The generic approach does
4867not support varargs.
4868@end deftypefn
4869
4870@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (const_tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, const_tree @var{function})
4871A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4872to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4873arguments it is passed, and false otherwise.  In the latter case, the
4874generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4875previously exposed.
4876@end deftypefn
4877
4878@node Profiling
4879@subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4880@cindex profiling, code generation
4881
4882These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4883
4884@defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4885A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4886assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4887
4888@findex mcount
4889The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4890your operating system environment, not by GCC@.  To figure them out,
4891compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4892compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4893
4894Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4895variable to be loaded into some register.  The name of this variable is
4896@samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4897the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4898@end defmac
4899
4900@defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4901A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4902code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4903not support profiling.
4904@end defmac
4905
4906@defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4907Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4908@code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4909allocated for each function.  This is true for almost all modern
4910implementations.  If you define this macro, you must not use the
4911@var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4912@end defmac
4913
4914@defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4915Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4916the function prologue.  Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4917@end defmac
4918
4919@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_KEEP_LEAF_WHEN_PROFILED (void)
4920This target hook returns true if the target wants the leaf flag for the current function to stay true even if it calls mcount.  This might make sense for targets using the leaf flag only to determine whether a stack frame needs to be generated or not and for which the call to mcount is generated before the function prologue.
4921@end deftypefn
4922
4923@node Tail Calls
4924@subsection Permitting tail calls
4925@cindex tail calls
4926
4927@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{exp})
4928True if it is OK to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4929call expression @var{exp}.  @var{decl} will be the called function,
4930or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4931
4932It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4933tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4934during PIC compilation.  The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4935as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4936``normal'' call.  The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4937may vary greatly between different architectures.
4938@end deftypefn
4939
4940@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY (bitmap @var{regs})
4941Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4942function.  This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4943cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4944registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4945TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4946FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4947@end deftypefn
4948
4949@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_UP_BY_PROLOGUE (struct hard_reg_set_container *@var{})
4950This hook should add additional registers that are computed by the prologue to the hard regset for shrink-wrapping optimization purposes.
4951@end deftypefn
4952
4953@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WARN_FUNC_RETURN (tree)
4954True if a function's return statements should be checked for matching the function's return type.  This includes checking for falling off the end of a non-void function.  Return false if no such check should be made.
4955@end deftypefn
4956
4957@node Shrink-wrapping separate components
4958@subsection Shrink-wrapping separate components
4959@cindex shrink-wrapping separate components
4960
4961The prologue may perform a variety of target dependent tasks such as
4962saving callee-saved registers, saving the return address, aligning the
4963stack, creating a stack frame, initializing the PIC register, setting
4964up the static chain, etc.
4965
4966On some targets some of these tasks may be independent of others and
4967thus may be shrink-wrapped separately.  These independent tasks are
4968referred to as components and are handled generically by the target
4969independent parts of GCC.
4970
4971Using the following hooks those prologue or epilogue components can be
4972shrink-wrapped separately, so that the initialization (and possibly
4973teardown) those components do is not done as frequently on execution
4974paths where this would unnecessary.
4975
4976What exactly those components are is up to the target code; the generic
4977code treats them abstractly, as a bit in an @code{sbitmap}.  These
4978@code{sbitmap}s are allocated by the @code{shrink_wrap.get_separate_components}
4979and @code{shrink_wrap.components_for_bb} hooks, and deallocated by the
4980generic code.
4981
4982@deftypefn {Target Hook} sbitmap TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_GET_SEPARATE_COMPONENTS (void)
4983This hook should return an @code{sbitmap} with the bits set for those
4984components that can be separately shrink-wrapped in the current function.
4985Return @code{NULL} if the current function should not get any separate
4986shrink-wrapping.
4987Don't define this hook if it would always return @code{NULL}.
4988If it is defined, the other hooks in this group have to be defined as well.
4989@end deftypefn
4990
4991@deftypefn {Target Hook} sbitmap TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_COMPONENTS_FOR_BB (basic_block)
4992This hook should return an @code{sbitmap} with the bits set for those
4993components where either the prologue component has to be executed before
4994the @code{basic_block}, or the epilogue component after it, or both.
4995@end deftypefn
4996
4997@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_DISQUALIFY_COMPONENTS (sbitmap @var{components}, edge @var{e}, sbitmap @var{edge_components}, bool @var{is_prologue})
4998This hook should clear the bits in the @var{components} bitmap for those
4999components in @var{edge_components} that the target cannot handle on edge
5000@var{e}, where @var{is_prologue} says if this is for a prologue or an
5001epilogue instead.
5002@end deftypefn
5003
5004@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_EMIT_PROLOGUE_COMPONENTS (sbitmap)
5005Emit prologue insns for the components indicated by the parameter.
5006@end deftypefn
5007
5008@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_EMIT_EPILOGUE_COMPONENTS (sbitmap)
5009Emit epilogue insns for the components indicated by the parameter.
5010@end deftypefn
5011
5012@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_SET_HANDLED_COMPONENTS (sbitmap)
5013Mark the components in the parameter as handled, so that the
5014@code{prologue} and @code{epilogue} named patterns know to ignore those
5015components.  The target code should not hang on to the @code{sbitmap}, it
5016will be deleted after this call.
5017@end deftypefn
5018
5019@node Stack Smashing Protection
5020@subsection Stack smashing protection
5021@cindex stack smashing protection
5022
5023@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD (void)
5024This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
5025for the stack protection guard.  This variable is initialized by the
5026runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
5027that is placed at the top of the local stack frame.  The type of this
5028variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
5029
5030The default version of this hook creates a variable called
5031@samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5032@end deftypefn
5033
5034@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL (void)
5035This hook returns a @code{CALL_EXPR} that alerts the runtime that the
5036stack protect guard variable has been modified.  This expression should
5037involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
5038
5039The default version of this hook invokes a function called
5040@samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments.  This function is
5041normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5042@end deftypefn
5043
5044@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_RUNTIME_ENABLED_P (void)
5045Returns true if the target wants GCC's default stack protect runtime support, otherwise return false.  The default implementation always returns true.
5046@end deftypefn
5047
5048@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK (bool @var{report}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
5049Whether this target supports splitting the stack when the options described in @var{opts} have been passed.  This is called after options have been parsed, so the target may reject splitting the stack in some configurations.  The default version of this hook returns false.  If @var{report} is true, this function may issue a warning or error; if @var{report} is false, it must simply return a value
5050@end deftypefn
5051
5052@node Miscellaneous Register Hooks
5053@subsection Miscellaneous register hooks
5054@cindex miscellaneous register hooks
5055
5056@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALL_FUSAGE_CONTAINS_NON_CALLEE_CLOBBERS
5057Set to true if each call that binds to a local definition explicitly
5058clobbers or sets all non-fixed registers modified by performing the call.
5059That is, by the call pattern itself, or by code that might be inserted by the
5060linker (e.g. stubs, veneers, branch islands), but not including those
5061modifiable by the callee.  The affected registers may be mentioned explicitly
5062in the call pattern, or included as clobbers in CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE.
5063The default version of this hook is set to false.  The purpose of this hook
5064is to enable the fipa-ra optimization.
5065@end deftypevr
5066
5067@node Varargs
5068@section Implementing the Varargs Macros
5069@cindex varargs implementation
5070
5071GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
5072@code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
5073on the stack.  Other machines require their own implementations of
5074varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
5075conditionals to include it.
5076
5077ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
5078the calling convention for @code{va_start}.  The traditional
5079implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
5080to store the argument pointer.  The ISO implementation of
5081@code{va_start} takes an additional second argument.  The user is
5082supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
5083
5084However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument.  The way to find
5085the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
5086below.
5087
5088@defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
5089Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
5090that the varargs mechanism can access them.  Both ISO and traditional
5091versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
5092you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
5093
5094On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
5095control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}.  On
5096other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
5097found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5098
5099Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
5100beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
5101@code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
5102This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
5103to use them for its own purposes.
5104@c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
5105@c 10feb93
5106@end defmac
5107
5108@defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
5109This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
5110argument, as type @code{void *}.  If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
5111returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
5112argument.  Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
5113fetching arguments from the stack.  Also use it in @code{va_start} to
5114verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
5115of the current function.
5116@end defmac
5117
5118@defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
5119Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
5120passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
5121has to embody these conventions.  The easiest way to categorize the
5122specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
5123with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
5124
5125@code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
5126considering only its data type.  It returns an integer describing what
5127kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
5128
5129The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
5130interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
5131@end defmac
5132
5133These machine description macros help implement varargs:
5134
5135@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS (void)
5136If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
5137@code{__builtin_saveregs}.  This code will be moved to the very
5138beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made.  The
5139return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
5140to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
5141@end deftypefn
5142
5143@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (cumulative_args_t @var{args_so_far}, machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
5144This target hook offers an alternative to using
5145@code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
5146@code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}.  Use it to store the anonymous
5147register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
5148have been passed consecutively on the stack.  Once this is done, you can
5149use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
5150pass all their arguments on the stack.
5151
5152The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
5153structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
5154named arguments.  The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
5155last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
5156
5157The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
5158argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
5159store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
5160variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}.  The value that you
5161store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
5162frame.
5163
5164Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
5165compile time without knowing their data types,
5166@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
5167have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5168for all data types.
5169
5170If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5171arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time.  This
5172happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
5173end of the source file.  The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
5174not generate any instructions in this case.
5175@end deftypefn
5176
5177@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
5178Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
5179argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
5180
5181This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
5182is set for varargs and stdarg functions.  If this hook returns
5183@code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5184arguments, and false for unnamed arguments.  If it returns @code{false},
5185but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
5186then all arguments are treated as named.  Otherwise, all named arguments
5187except the last are treated as named.
5188
5189You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5190@end deftypefn
5191
5192@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CALL_ARGS (rtx, @var{tree})
5193While generating RTL for a function call, this target hook is invoked once
5194for each argument passed to the function, either a register returned by
5195@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} or a memory location.  It is called just
5196before the point where argument registers are stored.  The type of the
5197function to be called is also passed as the second argument; it is
5198@code{NULL_TREE} for libcalls.  The @code{TARGET_END_CALL_ARGS} hook is
5199invoked just after the code to copy the return reg has been emitted.
5200This functionality can be used to perform special setup of call argument
5201registers if a target needs it.
5202For functions without arguments, the hook is called once with @code{pc_rtx}
5203passed instead of an argument register.
5204Most ports do not need to implement anything for this hook.
5205@end deftypefn
5206
5207@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_END_CALL_ARGS (void)
5208This target hook is invoked while generating RTL for a function call,
5209just after the point where the return reg is copied into a pseudo.  It
5210signals that all the call argument and return registers for the just
5211emitted call are now no longer in use.
5212Most ports do not need to implement anything for this hook.
5213@end deftypefn
5214
5215@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
5216If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5217@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5218@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5219defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5220@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5221Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5222@end deftypefn
5223
5224@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LOAD_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG (rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{arg}, rtx @var{slot_no})
5225This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to load bounds of
5226@var{arg} passed in @var{slot}.  Expand pass uses this hook in case
5227bounds of @var{arg} are not passed in register.  If @var{slot} is a
5228memory, then bounds are loaded as for regular pointer loaded from
5229memory.  If @var{slot} is not a memory then @var{slot_no} is an integer
5230constant holding number of the target dependent special slot which
5231should be used to obtain bounds.  Hook returns RTX holding loaded bounds.
5232@end deftypefn
5233
5234@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_STORE_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG (rtx @var{arg}, rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{bounds}, rtx @var{slot_no})
5235This hook is used by expand pass to emit insns to store @var{bounds} of
5236@var{arg} passed in @var{slot}.  Expand pass uses this hook in case
5237@var{bounds} of @var{arg} are not passed in register.  If @var{slot} is a
5238memory, then @var{bounds} are stored as for regular pointer stored in
5239memory.  If @var{slot} is not a memory then @var{slot_no} is an integer
5240constant holding number of the target dependent special slot which
5241should be used to store @var{bounds}.
5242@end deftypefn
5243
5244@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LOAD_RETURNED_BOUNDS (rtx @var{slot})
5245This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to load bounds
5246returned by function call in @var{slot}.  Hook returns RTX holding
5247loaded bounds.
5248@end deftypefn
5249
5250@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_STORE_RETURNED_BOUNDS (rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{bounds})
5251This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to store @var{bounds}
5252returned by function call into @var{slot}.
5253@end deftypefn
5254
5255@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_CHKP_FUNCTION_VALUE_BOUNDS (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
5256Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
5257returns bounds for returned pointers.  Arguments meaning is similar to
5258@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE}.
5259@end deftypefn
5260
5261@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARG_BOUNDS (cumulative_args_t @var{args_so_far}, machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
5262Use it to store bounds for anonymous register arguments stored
5263into the stack.  Arguments meaning is similar to
5264@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}.
5265@end deftypefn
5266
5267@node Trampolines
5268@section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5269@cindex trampolines for nested functions
5270@cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5271
5272A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5273when the address of a nested function is taken.  It normally resides on
5274the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function.  These macros
5275tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
5276trampoline.
5277
5278The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5279address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5280the nested function.  On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5281two instructions, a move immediate and a jump.  Then the two addresses
5282exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands.  On RISC
5283machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5284two parts.  Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5285operands.
5286
5287The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5288parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5289immediate operands of the instructions.  On a CISC machine, this is
5290simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5291proper offset from the start of the trampoline.  On a RISC machine, it
5292may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5293separately.
5294
5295@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (FILE *@var{f})
5296This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5297on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5298the constant parts of a trampoline.  This code should not include a
5299label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5300
5301If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5302for the target.  Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5303code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5304to generate it on the spot.
5305@end deftypefn
5306
5307@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5308Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5309(@pxref{Sections}).  The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5310@end defmac
5311
5312@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5313A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5314@end defmac
5315
5316@defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5317Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5318
5319If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5320is used for aligning trampolines.
5321@end defmac
5322
5323@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT (rtx @var{m_tramp}, tree @var{fndecl}, rtx @var{static_chain})
5324This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5325@var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5326is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5327RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5328when it is called.
5329
5330If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5331first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5332from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
5333Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
5334trampoline.  If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5335to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5336
5337If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
5338enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
5339initializing the trampoline proper.
5340@end deftypefn
5341
5342@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (rtx @var{addr})
5343This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5344the address of the trampoline.  Its argument contains the address of the
5345memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}.  In case
5346the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5347address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5348be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5349If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5350@end deftypefn
5351
5352@deftypevr {Target Hook} int TARGET_CUSTOM_FUNCTION_DESCRIPTORS
5353This hook should be defined to a power of 2 if the target will benefit
5354from the use of custom descriptors for nested functions instead of the
5355standard trampolines.  Such descriptors are created at run time on the
5356stack and made up of data only, but they are non-standard so the generated
5357code must be prepared to deal with them.  This hook should be defined to 0
5358if the target uses function descriptors for its standard calling sequence,
5359like for example HP-PA or IA-64.  Using descriptors for nested functions
5360eliminates the need for trampolines that reside on the stack and require
5361it to be made executable.
5362
5363The value of the macro is used to parameterize the run-time identification
5364scheme implemented to distinguish descriptors from function addresses: it
5365gives the number of bytes by which their address is misaligned compared
5366with function addresses.  The value of 1 will generally work, unless it is
5367already reserved by the target for another purpose, like for example on ARM.
5368@end deftypevr
5369
5370Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5371separate instruction and data caches.  Writing into a stack location
5372fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5373jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5374
5375Here are two possible solutions.  One is to clear the relevant parts of
5376the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up.  The other is to
5377make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5378subroutine.  The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5379latter makes initialization faster.
5380
5381To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5382the following macro.
5383
5384@defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5385If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5386cache} in the specified interval.  The definition of this macro would
5387typically be a series of @code{asm} statements.  Both @var{beg} and
5388@var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5389@end defmac
5390
5391To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro.  In addition,
5392you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5393cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5394beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5395its cache line.  Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5396
5397@defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5398Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5399work.  The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5400which will be compiled with GCC@.  They go in a library function named
5401@code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5402
5403If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5404C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5405special label of your own in the assembler code.  Use one @code{asm}
5406statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5407global.  Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5408special assembler code.
5409@end defmac
5410
5411@node Library Calls
5412@section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5413@cindex library subroutine names
5414@cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5415
5416@c prevent bad page break with this line
5417Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5418
5419@defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5420This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5421expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a.  It can be used to
5422provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5423are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5424@end defmac
5425
5426@findex set_optab_libfunc
5427@findex init_one_libfunc
5428@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS (void)
5429This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5430existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5431@code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5432@code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5433library routines.
5434
5435The default is to do nothing.  Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5436@end deftypefn
5437
5438@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX
5439If false (the default), internal library routines start with two
5440underscores.  If set to true, these routines start with @code{__gnu_}
5441instead.  E.g., @code{__muldi3} changes to @code{__gnu_muldi3}.  This
5442currently only affects functions defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.  If this
5443is set to true, the @file{tm.h} file must also
5444@code{#define LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX}.
5445@end deftypevr
5446
5447@defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5448This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5449implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5450mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5451return a tristate.
5452
5453GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5454comparison operators, so the default returns false always.  Most ports
5455don't need to define this macro.
5456@end defmac
5457
5458@defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5459This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5460functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5461operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5462and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5463If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5464@minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2.  If the target uses the routines
5465in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5466@end defmac
5467
5468@defmac TARGET_HAS_NO_HW_DIVIDE
5469This macro should be defined if the target has no hardware divide
5470instructions.  If this macro is defined, GCC will use an algorithm which
5471make use of simple logical and arithmetic operations for 64-bit
5472division.  If the macro is not defined, GCC will use an algorithm which
5473make use of a 64-bit by 32-bit divide primitive.
5474@end defmac
5475
5476@cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5477@findex matherr
5478@defmac TARGET_EDOM
5479The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5480expression.  If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5481deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly.  Look in
5482@file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5483system.
5484
5485If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5486domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5487error.  If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5488there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5489that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5490@end defmac
5491
5492@cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5493@defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5494Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5495refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}.  (On certain systems,
5496@code{errno} may not actually be a variable.)  If you don't define this
5497macro, a reasonable default is used.
5498@end defmac
5499
5500@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBC_HAS_FUNCTION (enum function_class @var{fn_class})
5501This hook determines whether a function from a class of functions
5502@var{fn_class} is present at the runtime.
5503@end deftypefn
5504
5505@defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
5506Set this macro to 1 to use the "NeXT" Objective-C message sending conventions
5507by default.  This calling convention involves passing the object, the selector
5508and the method arguments all at once to the method-lookup library function.
5509This is the usual setting when targeting Darwin/Mac OS X systems, which have
5510the NeXT runtime installed.
5511
5512If the macro is set to 0, the "GNU" Objective-C message sending convention
5513will be used by default.  This convention passes just the object and the
5514selector to the method-lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5515
5516In either case, it remains possible to select code-generation for the alternate
5517scheme, by means of compiler command line switches.
5518@end defmac
5519
5520@node Addressing Modes
5521@section Addressing Modes
5522@cindex addressing modes
5523
5524@c prevent bad page break with this line
5525This is about addressing modes.
5526
5527@defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5528@defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5529@defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5530@defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5531A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5532pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5533@end defmac
5534
5535@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5536@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5537A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5538post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5539the size of the memory operand.
5540@end defmac
5541
5542@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5543@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5544A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5545post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5546@end defmac
5547
5548@defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5549A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5550is a valid address.  On most machines the default definition of
5551@code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5552is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
5553constant addresses are supported.
5554@end defmac
5555
5556@defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5557@code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5558accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5559known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5560expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5561@code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5562@end defmac
5563
5564@defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5565A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5566memory address.  Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5567the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5568accept.
5569@end defmac
5570
5571@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, bool @var{strict})
5572A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5573address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5574
5575Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5576non-strict one.  The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5577desired by the caller.
5578
5579The strict variant is used in the reload pass.  It must be defined so
5580that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5581considered a memory reference.  This is because in contexts where some
5582kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5583must be rejected.  For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5584up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5585register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5586if the array holds @code{-1}.
5587
5588The non-strict variant is used in other passes.  It must be defined to
5589accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5590register is required.
5591
5592Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5593and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5594constant.  Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5595specifically as legitimate addresses.  Normally you would simply
5596recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5597
5598Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5599sums that are not marked with  @code{const}.  It assumes that a naked
5600@code{plus} indicates indexing.  If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5601naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5602be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5603
5604@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5605On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5606the section that the address refers to.  On these machines, define the
5607target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5608into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here.  When you see a
5609@code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5610@code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section.  @xref{Assembler
5611Format}.
5612
5613@cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5614Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5615this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro.  This macro
5616has this syntax:
5617
5618@example
5619#define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5620@end example
5621
5622@noindent
5623and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5624address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5625
5626@findex REG_OK_STRICT
5627Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5628macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}.  You should use an
5629@code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5630that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5631
5632Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5633files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5634@end deftypefn
5635
5636@defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5637A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5638character for general memory addresses.  This defines the constraint
5639letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5640@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}.  Define this macro if you want to
5641support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5642semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint.  This is necessary in order to
5643preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5644@code{'m'} constraint.
5645@end defmac
5646
5647@defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5648A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5649or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5650can easily find the base term.  This macro is used in only two places:
5651@code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5652
5653It is always safe for this macro to not be defined.  It exists so
5654that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5655
5656The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5657a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5658@end defmac
5659
5660@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, machine_mode @var{mode})
5661This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5662operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5663address.
5664
5665@findex break_out_memory_refs
5666@var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5667and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5668@var{x}.
5669
5670The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5671@var{x}.  If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5672should return the new @var{x}.
5673
5674It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address,
5675with the exception of native TLS addresses (@pxref{Emulated TLS}).
5676The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases.  In fact, if
5677the target supports only emulated TLS, it
5678is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5679a valid way to legitimize the address.  But often a machine-dependent
5680strategy can generate better code.
5681@end deftypefn
5682
5683@defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5684A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5685that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5686@var{mode}.  @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5687It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5688performance reasons.
5689
5690For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5691reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5692registers into a register.  On the other hand, for number of RISC
5693processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5694needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot.  By defining
5695@code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5696generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5697be shared.
5698
5699@emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution.  It is necessary
5700to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5701and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5702of reload internals.
5703
5704@emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5705previous invocation of this macro.  If it fails to handle such addresses
5706then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5707
5708@findex push_reload
5709The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5710need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5711suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5712
5713The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5714@var{x}.  If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5715should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5716This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5717@code{push_reload}.
5718
5719@findex strict_memory_address_p
5720The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5721the address has become legitimate.
5722
5723@findex copy_rtx
5724If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5725this is to use @code{copy_rtx}.  Note, however, that it unshares only a
5726single level of rtl.  Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5727top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5728It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5729address;  but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5730@end defmac
5731
5732@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P (const_rtx @var{addr}, addr_space_t @var{addrspace})
5733This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} in address
5734space @var{addrspace} can have
5735different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5736reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5737but not others.
5738
5739Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5740effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5741of the operand being addressed.  Some machines have other mode-dependent
5742addresses.  Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5743
5744You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5745
5746The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5747@end deftypefn
5748
5749@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5750This hook returns true if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for a
5751@var{mode}-mode immediate operand on the target machine.  You can assume that
5752@var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.
5753
5754The default definition returns true.
5755@end deftypefn
5756
5757@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x})
5758This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5759@code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5760macros.  Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5761references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5762addressing modes.  This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5763the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5764into their original form.
5765@end deftypefn
5766
5767@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CONST_NOT_OK_FOR_DEBUG_P (rtx @var{x})
5768This hook should return true if @var{x} should not be emitted into
5769debug sections.
5770@end deftypefn
5771
5772@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5773This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
5774should not) be spilled to the constant pool.  @var{mode} is the mode
5775of @var{x}.
5776
5777The default version of this hook returns false.
5778
5779The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5780deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5781from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5782holding the constant.  This restriction is often true of addresses
5783of TLS symbols for various targets.
5784@end deftypefn
5785
5786@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{x})
5787This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5788be placed in an @code{object_block} structure.  @var{mode} is the mode
5789of @var{x}.
5790
5791The default version returns false for all constants.
5792@end deftypefn
5793
5794@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_DECL_P (const_tree @var{decl})
5795This hook should return true if pool entries for @var{decl} should
5796be placed in an @code{object_block} structure.
5797
5798The default version returns true for all decls.
5799@end deftypefn
5800
5801@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL (tree @var{fndecl})
5802This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements the
5803reciprocal of the machine-specific builtin function @var{fndecl}, or
5804@code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5805@end deftypefn
5806
5807@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD (void)
5808This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5809address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5810used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5811@var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5812
5813The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5814@var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5815the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5816@code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5817two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5818@var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5819the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5820from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5821@var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5822@var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5823@var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5824
5825If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5826to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5827use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5828@code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5829should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5830described above.
5831If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5832the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5833log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5834@end deftypefn
5835
5836@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST (enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{type_of_cost}, tree @var{vectype}, int @var{misalign})
5837Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
5838For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
5839misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
5840@end deftypefn
5841
5842@deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT (const_tree @var{type})
5843This hook returns the preferred alignment in bits for accesses to
5844vectors of type @var{type} in vectorized code.  This might be less than
5845or greater than the ABI-defined value returned by
5846@code{TARGET_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT}.  It can be equal to the alignment of
5847a single element, in which case the vectorizer will not try to optimize
5848for alignment.
5849
5850The default hook returns @code{TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type})}, which is
5851correct for most targets.
5852@end deftypefn
5853
5854@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE (const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{is_packed})
5855Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given scalar type @var{type}.  @var{is_packed} is false if the scalar access using @var{type} is known to be naturally aligned.
5856@end deftypefn
5857
5858@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VEC_PERM_CONST (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{output}, rtx @var{in0}, rtx @var{in1}, const vec_perm_indices @var{&sel})
5859This hook is used to test whether the target can permute up to two
5860vectors of mode @var{mode} using the permutation vector @code{sel}, and
5861also to emit such a permutation.  In the former case @var{in0}, @var{in1}
5862and @var{out} are all null.  In the latter case @var{in0} and @var{in1} are
5863the source vectors and @var{out} is the destination vector; all three are
5864registers of mode @var{mode}.  @var{in1} is the same as @var{in0} if
5865@var{sel} describes a permutation on one vector instead of two.
5866
5867Return true if the operation is possible, emitting instructions for it
5868if rtxes are provided.
5869
5870@cindex @code{vec_perm@var{m}} instruction pattern
5871If the hook returns false for a mode with multibyte elements, GCC will
5872try the equivalent byte operation.  If that also fails, it will try forcing
5873the selector into a register and using the @var{vec_perm@var{mode}}
5874instruction pattern.  There is no need for the hook to handle these two
5875implementation approaches itself.
5876@end deftypefn
5877
5878@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION (unsigned @var{code}, tree @var{dest_type}, tree @var{src_type})
5879This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
5880input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
5881The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5882specifies how the conversion is to be applied
5883(truncation, rounding, etc.).
5884
5885If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5886@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5887conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5888@end deftypefn
5889
5890@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (unsigned @var{code}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in})
5891This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5892vectorized variant of the function with the @code{combined_fn} code
5893@var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5894The return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5895@var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5896@end deftypefn
5897
5898@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MD_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in})
5899This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5900vectorized variant of target built-in function @code{fndecl}.  The
5901return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5902@var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5903@end deftypefn
5904
5905@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, int @var{misalignment}, bool @var{is_packed})
5906This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5907store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5908parameter.  The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5909the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}.  @var{is_packed}
5910parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5911@end deftypefn
5912
5913@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE (scalar_mode @var{mode})
5914This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5915mode @var{mode}.  The default is
5916equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
5917transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5918@end deftypefn
5919
5920@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_VECTORIZE_SPLIT_REDUCTION (machine_mode)
5921This hook should return the preferred mode to split the final reduction
5922step on @var{mode} to.  The reduction is then carried out reducing upper
5923against lower halves of vectors recursively until the specified mode is
5924reached.  The default is @var{mode} which means no splitting.
5925@end deftypefn
5926
5927@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES (vector_sizes *@var{sizes})
5928If the mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE} is not
5929the only one that is worth considering, this hook should add all suitable
5930vector sizes to @var{sizes}, in order of decreasing preference.  The first
5931one should be the size of @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5932
5933The hook does not need to do anything if the vector returned by
5934@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE} is the only one relevant
5935for autovectorization.  The default implementation does nothing.
5936@end deftypefn
5937
5938@deftypefn {Target Hook} opt_machine_mode TARGET_VECTORIZE_GET_MASK_MODE (poly_uint64 @var{nunits}, poly_uint64 @var{length})
5939A vector mask is a value that holds one boolean result for every element
5940in a vector.  This hook returns the machine mode that should be used to
5941represent such a mask when the vector in question is @var{length} bytes
5942long and contains @var{nunits} elements.  The hook returns an empty
5943@code{opt_machine_mode} if no such mode exists.
5944
5945The default implementation returns the mode of an integer vector that
5946is @var{length} bytes long and that contains @var{nunits} elements,
5947if such a mode exists.
5948@end deftypefn
5949
5950@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_EMPTY_MASK_IS_EXPENSIVE (unsigned @var{ifn})
5951This hook returns true if masked internal function @var{ifn} (really of
5952type @code{internal_fn}) should be considered expensive when the mask is
5953all zeros.  GCC can then try to branch around the instruction instead.
5954@end deftypefn
5955
5956@deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST (struct loop *@var{loop_info})
5957This hook should initialize target-specific data structures in preparation for modeling the costs of vectorizing a loop or basic block.  The default allocates three unsigned integers for accumulating costs for the prologue, body, and epilogue of the loop or basic block.  If @var{loop_info} is non-NULL, it identifies the loop being vectorized; otherwise a single block is being vectorized.
5958@end deftypefn
5959
5960@deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_VECTORIZE_ADD_STMT_COST (void *@var{data}, int @var{count}, enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{kind}, struct _stmt_vec_info *@var{stmt_info}, int @var{misalign}, enum vect_cost_model_location @var{where})
5961This hook should update the target-specific @var{data} in response to adding @var{count} copies of the given @var{kind} of statement to a loop or basic block.  The default adds the builtin vectorizer cost for the copies of the statement to the accumulator specified by @var{where}, (the prologue, body, or epilogue) and returns the amount added.  The return value should be viewed as a tentative cost that may later be revised.
5962@end deftypefn
5963
5964@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_FINISH_COST (void *@var{data}, unsigned *@var{prologue_cost}, unsigned *@var{body_cost}, unsigned *@var{epilogue_cost})
5965This hook should complete calculations of the cost of vectorizing a loop or basic block based on @var{data}, and return the prologue, body, and epilogue costs as unsigned integers.  The default returns the value of the three accumulators.
5966@end deftypefn
5967
5968@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_DESTROY_COST_DATA (void *@var{data})
5969This hook should release @var{data} and any related data structures allocated by TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST.  The default releases the accumulator.
5970@end deftypefn
5971
5972@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_GATHER (const_tree @var{mem_vectype}, const_tree @var{index_type}, int @var{scale})
5973Target builtin that implements vector gather operation.  @var{mem_vectype}
5974is the vector type of the load and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
5975the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
5976The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize gather
5977loads.
5978@end deftypefn
5979
5980@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_SCATTER (const_tree @var{vectype}, const_tree @var{index_type}, int @var{scale})
5981Target builtin that implements vector scatter operation.  @var{vectype}
5982is the vector type of the store and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
5983the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
5984The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize scatter
5985stores.
5986@end deftypefn
5987
5988@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_COMPUTE_VECSIZE_AND_SIMDLEN (struct cgraph_node *@var{}, struct cgraph_simd_clone *@var{}, @var{tree}, @var{int})
5989This hook should set @var{vecsize_mangle}, @var{vecsize_int}, @var{vecsize_float}
5990fields in @var{simd_clone} structure pointed by @var{clone_info} argument and also
5991@var{simdlen} field if it was previously 0.
5992The hook should return 0 if SIMD clones shouldn't be emitted,
5993or number of @var{vecsize_mangle} variants that should be emitted.
5994@end deftypefn
5995
5996@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_ADJUST (struct cgraph_node *@var{})
5997This hook should add implicit @code{attribute(target("..."))} attribute
5998to SIMD clone @var{node} if needed.
5999@end deftypefn
6000
6001@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_USABLE (struct cgraph_node *@var{})
6002This hook should return -1 if SIMD clone @var{node} shouldn't be used
6003in vectorized loops in current function, or non-negative number if it is
6004usable.  In that case, the smaller the number is, the more desirable it is
6005to use it.
6006@end deftypefn
6007
6008@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMT_VF (void)
6009Return number of threads in SIMT thread group on the target.
6010@end deftypefn
6011
6012@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GOACC_VALIDATE_DIMS (tree @var{decl}, int *@var{dims}, int @var{fn_level})
6013This hook should check the launch dimensions provided for an OpenACC
6014compute region, or routine.  Defaulted values are represented as -1
6015and non-constant values as 0.  The @var{fn_level} is negative for the
6016function corresponding to the compute region.  For a routine is is the
6017outermost level at which partitioned execution may be spawned.  The hook
6018should verify non-default values.  If DECL is NULL, global defaults
6019are being validated and unspecified defaults should be filled in.
6020Diagnostics should be issued as appropriate.  Return
6021true, if changes have been made.  You must override this hook to
6022provide dimensions larger than 1.
6023@end deftypefn
6024
6025@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_GOACC_DIM_LIMIT (int @var{axis})
6026This hook should return the maximum size of a particular dimension,
6027or zero if unbounded.
6028@end deftypefn
6029
6030@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GOACC_FORK_JOIN (gcall *@var{call}, const int *@var{dims}, bool @var{is_fork})
6031This hook can be used to convert IFN_GOACC_FORK and IFN_GOACC_JOIN
6032function calls to target-specific gimple, or indicate whether they
6033should be retained.  It is executed during the oacc_device_lower pass.
6034It should return true, if the call should be retained.  It should
6035return false, if it is to be deleted (either because target-specific
6036gimple has been inserted before it, or there is no need for it).
6037The default hook returns false, if there are no RTL expanders for them.
6038@end deftypefn
6039
6040@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_GOACC_REDUCTION (gcall *@var{call})
6041This hook is used by the oacc_transform pass to expand calls to the
6042@var{GOACC_REDUCTION} internal function, into a sequence of gimple
6043instructions.  @var{call} is gimple statement containing the call to
6044the function.  This hook removes statement @var{call} after the
6045expanded sequence has been inserted.  This hook is also responsible
6046for allocating any storage for reductions when necessary.
6047@end deftypefn
6048
6049@node Anchored Addresses
6050@section Anchored Addresses
6051@cindex anchored addresses
6052@cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
6053
6054GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
6055For example, if we have:
6056
6057@smallexample
6058static int a, b, c;
6059int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
6060@end smallexample
6061
6062the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
6063addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}.  On some targets,
6064it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
6065the three variables relative to it.  The equivalent pseudocode would
6066be something like:
6067
6068@smallexample
6069int foo (void)
6070@{
6071  register int *xr = &x;
6072  return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
6073@}
6074@end smallexample
6075
6076(which isn't valid C).  We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
6077``section anchors''.  Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
6078
6079The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
6080in order to make effective use of section anchors.  It won't use
6081section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
6082or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
6083
6084@deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
6085The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
6086On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
6087applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
6088for every mode.  The default value is 0.
6089@end deftypevr
6090
6091@deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
6092Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
6093offset that should be applied to section anchors.  The default
6094value is 0.
6095@end deftypevr
6096
6097@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR (rtx @var{x})
6098Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
6099@code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
6100The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
6101of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
6102
6103If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
6104it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
6105If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
6106is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
6107@end deftypefn
6108
6109@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P (const_rtx @var{x})
6110Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
6111@var{x}.  You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
6112@samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
6113
6114The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
6115intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
6116or target-specific sections.
6117@end deftypefn
6118
6119@node Condition Code
6120@section Condition Code Status
6121@cindex condition code status
6122
6123The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
6124two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
6125
6126The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
6127(@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
6128clobber of the condition codes.  The second is the condition code
6129register representation, which provides better schedulability for
6130architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
6131most instructions do not affect it.  The latter category includes
6132most RISC machines.
6133
6134The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
6135the definition and use of the condition code.  In the past the definition
6136and use were always adjacent.  However, recent changes to support trapping
6137arithmatic may result in the definition and user being in different blocks.
6138Thus, there may be a @code{NOTE_INSN_BASIC_BLOCK} between them.  Additionally,
6139the definition may be the source of exception handling edges.
6140
6141These restrictions can prevent important
6142optimizations on some machines.  For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
6143is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
6144three instructions earlier than the conditional branch.  The instruction
6145scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
6146separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
6147
6148For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
6149represent the condition code for new ports.  If there is a specific
6150condition code register in the machine, use a hard register.  If the
6151condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
6152or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
6153Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
6154that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
6155
6156Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
6157specified already in the compare instruction.  In this case, you are not
6158interested in most macros in this section.
6159
6160@menu
6161* CC0 Condition Codes::      Old style representation of condition codes.
6162* MODE_CC Condition Codes::  Modern representation of condition codes.
6163@end menu
6164
6165@node CC0 Condition Codes
6166@subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
6167@findex cc0
6168
6169@findex cc_status
6170The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
6171describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
6172the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by).  This
6173variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
6174currently based, and several standard flags.
6175
6176Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
6177description header file.  It can also add additional machine-specific
6178information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
6179
6180@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
6181C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
6182component of @code{cc_status}.  It defaults to @code{int}.
6183
6184This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
6185@end defmac
6186
6187@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
6188A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
6189The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
6190the field anyway.  If you want to use the field, you should probably
6191define this macro to initialize it.
6192
6193This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
6194@end defmac
6195
6196@defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
6197A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
6198appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}.  It is
6199this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
6200code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
6201set @code{(cc0)}.
6202
6203This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
6204
6205If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
6206other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
6207invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
6208reflecting.  For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
6209registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
6210@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
6211insns.  But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
6212based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
6213value in @samp{a4}.  Although the condition code is not changed by
6214this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
6215@samp{a4@@(102)}.  Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
6216@code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
6217condition code value.
6218
6219The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
6220with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
6221@code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
6222constants which are just the operands.  The RTL structure of these
6223insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do.  What
6224@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
6225@code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
6226
6227A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
6228that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
6229@samp{cc}.  This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
6230two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
6231@end defmac
6232
6233@node MODE_CC Condition Codes
6234@subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
6235@findex CCmode
6236@findex MODE_CC
6237
6238@defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
6239On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
6240than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
6241code set by a subtract instruction.  However, on some machines
6242when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
6243bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
6244branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches.  When
6245this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
6246record different formats of the condition code register.  Modes can
6247also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
6248unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
6249
6250If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
6251@file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
6252a mode given an operand of a compare.  This is needed because the modes
6253have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
6254by instruction combination.  The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
6255be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
6256the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
6257
6258@smallexample
6259(define_insn ""
6260  [(set (reg:CCNZ 0)
6261        (compare:CCNZ
6262          (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
6263                   (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
6264          (const_int 0)))]
6265  ""
6266  "@dots{}")
6267@end smallexample
6268
6269@noindent
6270together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CCNZmode}
6271for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
6272
6273@smallexample
6274#define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
6275  (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT           \
6276   ? ((OP == LT || OP == LE || OP == GT || OP == GE)     \
6277      ? CCFPEmode : CCFPmode)                            \
6278   : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS     \
6279       || GET_CODE (X) == NEG || GET_CODE (x) == ASHIFT) \
6280      ? CCNZmode : CCmode))
6281@end smallexample
6282
6283Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
6284were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
6285this section.
6286
6287You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
6288in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
6289@end defmac
6290
6291@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (int *@var{code}, rtx *@var{op0}, rtx *@var{op1}, bool @var{op0_preserve_value})
6292On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
6293convert an invalid comparison into a valid one.  For example, the Alpha
6294does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
6295comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
6296
6297On such machines, implement this hook to do any required conversions.
6298@var{code} is the initial comparison code and @var{op0} and @var{op1}
6299are the left and right operands of the comparison, respectively.  If
6300@var{op0_preserve_value} is @code{true} the implementation is not
6301allowed to change the value of @var{op0} since the value might be used
6302in RTXs which aren't comparisons.  E.g. the implementation is not
6303allowed to swap operands in that case.
6304
6305GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
6306valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
6307@file{md} file.
6308
6309You need not to implement this hook if it would never change the
6310comparison code or operands.
6311@end deftypefn
6312
6313@defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
6314A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
6315comparison whose mode is @var{mode}.  If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
6316can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
6317then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
6318
6319You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
6320floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
6321For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
6322inequality comparisons are given either @code{CCFPEmode} or @code{CCFPmode}:
6323
6324@smallexample
6325#define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) \
6326   ((MODE) != CCFPEmode && (MODE) != CCFPmode)
6327@end smallexample
6328@end defmac
6329
6330@defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
6331A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
6332comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}.  The macro is used only in case
6333@code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero.  Define this macro in case
6334machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals.  For
6335instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
6336freely convert unordered compares to ordered ones.  Then definition may look
6337like:
6338
6339@smallexample
6340#define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
6341   ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
6342    : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
6343@end smallexample
6344@end defmac
6345
6346@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS (unsigned int *@var{p1}, unsigned int *@var{p2})
6347On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6348register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6349regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6350hard register is set to a common value.  Use this hook to enable a
6351small pass which optimizes such cases.  This hook should return true
6352to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6353arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6354When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
6355integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
6356@code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6357
6358The default version of this hook returns false.
6359@end deftypefn
6360
6361@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE (machine_mode @var{m1}, machine_mode @var{m2})
6362On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6363@code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6364validly done in more than one mode.  On such a system, define this
6365target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6366both comparisons may be validly done.  If there is no such mode,
6367return @code{VOIDmode}.
6368
6369The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6370same.  If they are, it returns that mode.  If they are different, it
6371returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6372@end deftypefn
6373
6374@deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FLAGS_REGNUM
6375If the target has a dedicated flags register, and it needs to use the post-reload comparison elimination pass, then this value should be set appropriately.
6376@end deftypevr
6377
6378@node Costs
6379@section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6380@cindex costs of instructions
6381@cindex relative costs
6382@cindex speed of instructions
6383
6384These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6385on the target machine.
6386
6387@defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6388A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6389register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}.  The classes are
6390expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.  A
6391value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6392that.
6393
6394It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6395same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6396registers if they are not general registers.
6397
6398If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6399hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6400classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6401constraints of the insn are met.  Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6402allow reload to verify that the constraints are met.  You should do this
6403if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6404
6405These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6406@code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6407@end defmac
6408
6409@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST (machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{from}, reg_class_t @var{to})
6410This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6411from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}.  The classes
6412are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6413A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6414that.
6415
6416It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6417same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6418registers if they are not general registers.
6419
6420If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6421hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6422classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6423constraints of the insn are met.  Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6424allow reload to verify that the constraints are met.  You should do this
6425if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6426
6427The default version of this function returns 2.
6428@end deftypefn
6429
6430@defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6431A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6432register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6433is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in.  This cost
6434is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.  If moving between
6435registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6436should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6437
6438If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6439the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6440needed.  If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6441between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6442more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6443reflect the actual cost of the move.
6444
6445GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6446secondary reloads are needed.  It computes the costs due to copying via
6447a secondary register.  If your machine copies from memory using a
6448secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
64494 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6450value to the result of that function.  The arguments to that function
6451are the same as to this macro.
6452
6453These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6454@code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6455@end defmac
6456
6457@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST (machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{rclass}, bool @var{in})
6458This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6459between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
6460if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6461This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6462If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6463registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6464
6465If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6466the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6467needed.  If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6468between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
6469more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6470reflect the actual cost of the move.
6471
6472GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6473secondary reloads are needed.  It computes the costs due to copying via
6474a secondary register.  If your machine copies from memory using a
6475secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
64764 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6477value to the result of that function.  The arguments to that function
6478are the same as to this target hook.
6479@end deftypefn
6480
6481@defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
6482A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction.  A value of 1 is
6483the default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter
6484@var{speed_p} is true when the branch in question should be optimized
6485for speed.  When it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should return a value
6486optimal for code size rather than performance.  @var{predictable_p} is
6487true for well-predicted branches. On many architectures the
6488@code{BRANCH_COST} can be reduced then.
6489@end defmac
6490
6491Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6492but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6493ordinarily expect.
6494
6495@defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6496Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6497than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6498faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6499require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6500between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6501
6502When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6503finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6504load will be used if alignment permits.  Unless bytes accesses are
6505faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6506may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6507other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6508@end defmac
6509
6510@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (machine_mode @var{mode}, unsigned int @var{align})
6511This hook returns true if memory accesses described by the
6512@var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6513than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap handler.
6514This hook is invoked only for unaligned accesses, i.e. when
6515@code{@var{alignment} < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (@var{mode})}.
6516
6517When this hook returns true, the compiler will act as if
6518@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were true when generating code for block
6519moves.  This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6520Therefore, do not make this hook return true if unaligned accesses only
6521add a cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6522
6523The hook must return true whenever @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is true.
6524The default implementation returns @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT}.
6525@end deftypefn
6526
6527@defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6528The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6529which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6530string move insn or a library call.  Increasing the value will always
6531make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6532
6533Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6534@code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6535the number of such sequences.
6536
6537The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6538optimized for speed rather than size.
6539
6540If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6541@end defmac
6542
6543@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BY_PIECES_INFRASTRUCTURE_P (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size}, unsigned int @var{alignment}, enum by_pieces_operation @var{op}, bool @var{speed_p})
6544GCC will attempt several strategies when asked to copy between
6545two areas of memory, or to set, clear or store to memory, for example
6546when copying a @code{struct}. The @code{by_pieces} infrastructure
6547implements such memory operations as a sequence of load, store or move
6548insns.  Alternate strategies are to expand the
6549@code{movmem} or @code{setmem} optabs, to emit a library call, or to emit
6550unit-by-unit, loop-based operations.
6551
6552This target hook should return true if, for a memory operation with a
6553given @var{size} and @var{alignment}, using the @code{by_pieces}
6554infrastructure is expected to result in better code generation.
6555Both @var{size} and @var{alignment} are measured in terms of storage
6556units.
6557
6558The parameter @var{op} is one of: @code{CLEAR_BY_PIECES},
6559@code{MOVE_BY_PIECES}, @code{SET_BY_PIECES}, @code{STORE_BY_PIECES} or
6560@code{COMPARE_BY_PIECES}.  These describe the type of memory operation
6561under consideration.
6562
6563The parameter @var{speed_p} is true if the code is currently being
6564optimized for speed rather than size.
6565
6566Returning true for higher values of @var{size} can improve code generation
6567for speed if the target does not provide an implementation of the
6568@code{movmem} or @code{setmem} standard names, if the @code{movmem} or
6569@code{setmem} implementation would be more expensive than a sequence of
6570insns, or if the overhead of a library call would dominate that of
6571the body of the memory operation.
6572
6573Returning true for higher values of @code{size} may also cause an increase
6574in code size, for example where the number of insns emitted to perform a
6575move would be greater than that of a library call.
6576@end deftypefn
6577
6578@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPARE_BY_PIECES_BRANCH_RATIO (machine_mode @var{mode})
6579When expanding a block comparison in MODE, gcc can try to reduce the
6580number of branches at the expense of more memory operations.  This hook
6581allows the target to override the default choice.  It should return the
6582factor by which branches should be reduced over the plain expansion with
6583one comparison per @var{mode}-sized piece.  A port can also prevent a
6584particular mode from being used for block comparisons by returning a
6585negative number from this hook.
6586@end deftypefn
6587
6588@defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6589A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6590a load or store used to copy memory is.  Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6591@end defmac
6592
6593@defmac STORE_MAX_PIECES
6594A C expression used by @code{store_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6595a store used to memory is.  Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX_PIECES}, or two times
6596the size of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, whichever is smaller.
6597@end defmac
6598
6599@defmac COMPARE_MAX_PIECES
6600A C expression used by @code{compare_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6601a load or store used to compare memory is.  Defaults to
6602@code{MOVE_MAX_PIECES}.
6603@end defmac
6604
6605@defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6606The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6607of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6608or a library call.  Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6609eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6610
6611The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6612optimized for speed rather than size.
6613
6614If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6615@end defmac
6616
6617@defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6618The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6619of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
6620a block set insn or a library call.
6621Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6622eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6623
6624The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6625optimized for speed rather than size.
6626
6627If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6628@end defmac
6629
6630@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6631A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6632thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
6633@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6634@end defmac
6635
6636@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6637A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6638thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
6639@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6640@end defmac
6641
6642@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6643A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6644thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
6645@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6646@end defmac
6647
6648@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6649A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6650thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
6651@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6652@end defmac
6653
6654@defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6655A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6656thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
6657@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6658@end defmac
6659
6660@defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6661A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6662thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
6663@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6664@end defmac
6665
6666@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6667This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6668thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
6669@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6670@end defmac
6671
6672@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6673This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6674thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
6675@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6676@end defmac
6677
6678@defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6679Define this macro to be true if it is as good or better to call a constant
6680function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6681@end defmac
6682
6683@defmac LOGICAL_OP_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6684Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6685@samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal.  This macro defaults to true if
6686@code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6687@end defmac
6688
6689@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTAB_SUPPORTED_P (int @var{op}, machine_mode @var{mode1}, machine_mode @var{mode2}, optimization_type @var{opt_type})
6690Return true if the optimizers should use optab @var{op} with
6691modes @var{mode1} and @var{mode2} for optimization type @var{opt_type}.
6692The optab is known to have an associated @file{.md} instruction
6693whose C condition is true.  @var{mode2} is only meaningful for conversion
6694optabs; for direct optabs it is a copy of @var{mode1}.
6695
6696For example, when called with @var{op} equal to @code{rint_optab} and
6697@var{mode1} equal to @code{DFmode}, the hook should say whether the
6698optimizers should use optab @code{rintdf2}.
6699
6700The default hook returns true for all inputs.
6701@end deftypefn
6702
6703@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RTX_COSTS (rtx @var{x}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{outer_code}, int @var{opno}, int *@var{total}, bool @var{speed})
6704This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6705
6706The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
6707available for examination in @var{x}, and the fact that @var{x} appears
6708as operand @var{opno} of an expression with rtx code @var{outer_code}.
6709That is, the hook can assume that there is some rtx @var{y} such
6710that @samp{GET_CODE (@var{y}) == @var{outer_code}} and such that
6711either (a) @samp{XEXP (@var{y}, @var{opno}) == @var{x}} or
6712(b) @samp{XVEC (@var{y}, @var{opno})} contains @var{x}.
6713
6714@var{mode} is @var{x}'s machine mode, or for cases like @code{const_int} that
6715do not have a mode, the mode in which @var{x} is used.
6716
6717In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6718@code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6719instructions.
6720
6721On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6722for the cost of the expression.  The hook should modify this value as
6723necessary.  Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6724for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6725operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6726
6727When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6728false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6729size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6730
6731The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6732processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6733@end deftypefn
6734
6735@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDRESS_COST (rtx @var{address}, machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as}, bool @var{speed})
6736This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6737@var{address}.  If not defined, the cost is computed from
6738the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6739
6740For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6741true cost of the addressing mode.  However, on RISC machines, all
6742instructions normally have the same length and execution time.  Hence
6743all addresses will have equal costs.
6744
6745In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6746the lowest cost will be used.  If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6747cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6748
6749For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6750and a constant is used twice in the same basic block.  When this macro
6751is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6752references will be indirect through that register.  On machines where
6753the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6754that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6755instruction and possibly require an additional register.  Proper
6756specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6757
6758This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6759
6760On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6761cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6762@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6763be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6764@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner.  This effect
6765should be considered in the definition of this macro.  Equivalent costs
6766should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6767registers on machines with lots of registers.
6768@end deftypefn
6769
6770@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_INSN_COST (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, bool @var{speed})
6771This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL instructions.
6772
6773In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6774@code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6775instructions.
6776
6777When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6778false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6779size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6780@end deftypefn
6781
6782@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MAX_NOCE_IFCVT_SEQ_COST (edge @var{e})
6783This hook returns a value in the same units as @code{TARGET_RTX_COSTS},
6784giving the maximum acceptable cost for a sequence generated by the RTL
6785if-conversion pass when conditional execution is not available.
6786The RTL if-conversion pass attempts to convert conditional operations
6787that would require a branch to a series of unconditional operations and
6788@code{mov@var{mode}cc} insns.  This hook returns the maximum cost of the
6789unconditional instructions and the @code{mov@var{mode}cc} insns.
6790RTL if-conversion is cancelled if the cost of the converted sequence
6791is greater than the value returned by this hook.
6792
6793@code{e} is the edge between the basic block containing the conditional
6794branch to the basic block which would be executed if the condition
6795were true.
6796
6797The default implementation of this hook uses the
6798@code{max-rtl-if-conversion-[un]predictable} parameters if they are set,
6799and uses a multiple of @code{BRANCH_COST} otherwise.
6800@end deftypefn
6801
6802@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NOCE_CONVERSION_PROFITABLE_P (rtx_insn *@var{seq}, struct noce_if_info *@var{if_info})
6803This hook returns true if the instruction sequence @code{seq} is a good
6804candidate as a replacement for the if-convertible sequence described in
6805@code{if_info}.
6806@end deftypefn
6807
6808@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NO_SPECULATION_IN_DELAY_SLOTS_P (void)
6809This predicate controls the use of the eager delay slot filler to disallow
6810speculatively executed instructions being placed in delay slots.  Targets
6811such as certain MIPS architectures possess both branches with and without
6812delay slots.  As the eager delay slot filler can decrease performance,
6813disabling it is beneficial when ordinary branches are available.  Use of
6814delay slot branches filled using the basic filler is often still desirable
6815as the delay slot can hide a pipeline bubble.
6816@end deftypefn
6817
6818@deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_ESTIMATED_POLY_VALUE (poly_int64 @var{val})
6819Return an estimate of the runtime value of @var{val}, for use in
6820things like cost calculations or profiling frequencies.  The default
6821implementation returns the lowest possible value of @var{val}.
6822@end deftypefn
6823
6824@node Scheduling
6825@section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6826
6827The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6828adjustment in order to produce good code.  GCC provides several target
6829hooks for this purpose.  It is usually enough to define just a few of
6830them: try the first ones in this list first.
6831
6832@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE (void)
6833This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6834issue at the same time on the target machine.  The default is one.
6835Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6836an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6837constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6838hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6839This value must be constant over the entire compilation.  If you need
6840it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
6841@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6842@end deftypefn
6843
6844@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{more})
6845This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6846from the ready list.  It should return the number of insns which can
6847still be issued in the current cycle.  The default is
6848@samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6849@code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6850You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6851than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6852@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6853debug output to.  @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6854@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.  @var{insn} is the instruction that
6855was scheduled.
6856@end deftypefn
6857
6858@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{dep_type1}, rtx_insn *@var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost}, unsigned int @var{dw})
6859This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6860relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through a
6861dependence of type dep_type, and strength @var{dw}.  It should return the new
6862value.  The default is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}.  This can be
6863used for example to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline
6864description that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost
6865as a data-dependence.  If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6866description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6867output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6868times of the first and the second insns.  If these values are not
6869acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too.  See also
6870@pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
6871@end deftypefn
6872
6873@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{priority})
6874This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
6875@var{insn}.  It should return the new priority.  Increase the priority to
6876execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
6877later.  Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6878scheduling priorities of insns.
6879@end deftypefn
6880
6881@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn **@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
6882This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6883list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6884combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6885@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6886debug output to.  @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6887@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.  @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6888list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled.  @var{n_readyp} is
6889a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list.  The scheduler
6890reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
6891@var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0].  @var{clock}
6892is the timer tick of the scheduler.  You may modify the ready list and
6893the number of ready insns.  The return value is the number of insns that
6894can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}.  See also
6895@samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6896@end deftypefn
6897
6898@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn **@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
6899Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time.  That
6900function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle.  This one
6901is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6902@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6903return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle.  Defining
6904this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6905scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6906cycle.  These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6907@end deftypefn
6908
6909@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_MACRO_FUSION_P (void)
6910This hook is used to check whether target platform supports macro fusion.
6911@end deftypefn
6912
6913@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_MACRO_FUSION_PAIR_P (rtx_insn *@var{prev}, rtx_insn *@var{curr})
6914This hook is used to check whether two insns should be macro fused for
6915a target microarchitecture. If this hook returns true for the given insn pair
6916(@var{prev} and @var{curr}), the scheduler will put them into a sched
6917group, and they will not be scheduled apart.  The two insns will be either
6918two SET insns or a compare and a conditional jump and this hook should
6919validate any dependencies needed to fuse the two insns together.
6920@end deftypefn
6921
6922@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK (rtx_insn *@var{head}, rtx_insn *@var{tail})
6923This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6924chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6925correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain.  For
6926example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6927analysis of dependencies.  This hook can use backward and forward
6928dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6929calculated.
6930@end deftypefn
6931
6932@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{max_ready})
6933This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6934instructions that are to be scheduled.  @var{file} is either a null
6935pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.  @var{verbose}
6936is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6937@var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6938region that can be live at the same time.  This can be used to allocate
6939scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
6940@end deftypefn
6941
6942@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6943This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6944instructions that are to be scheduled.  It can be used to perform
6945cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks.  @var{file}
6946is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6947to.  @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6948@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6949@end deftypefn
6950
6951@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{old_max_uid})
6952This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6953@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6954@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6955@var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6956@end deftypefn
6957
6958@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6959This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
6960@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6961@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6962@end deftypefn
6963
6964@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6965The hook returns an RTL insn.  The automaton state used in the
6966pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6967when the new simulated processor cycle starts.  Usage of the hook may
6968simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6969processors.  If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6970based pipeline description.  The default is not to change the state
6971when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6972@end deftypefn
6973
6974@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6975The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6976@end deftypefn
6977
6978@deftypefn {Target Hook} {rtx_insn *} TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6979The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6980to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6981simulated processor cycle finishes.
6982@end deftypefn
6983
6984@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6985The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6986used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6987@end deftypefn
6988
6989@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
6990The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6991The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6992to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6993state on a single insn is not enough.
6994@end deftypefn
6995
6996@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
6997The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6998The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6999to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
7000state on a single insn is not enough.
7001@end deftypefn
7002
7003@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD (void)
7004This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
7005for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler.  Usually the scheduler
7006chooses the first insn from the queue.  If the hook returns a positive
7007value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
7008@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
7009subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
7010maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle.  For the
7011@acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
7012packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn.  Of course, if the
7013rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
7014
7015This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
7016processors.  Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
7017with 3 pipelines.  Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
7018@var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
7019@var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}.  The
7020processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
7021@var{B}.  In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
7022until the next cycle.  If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
7023the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
7024
7025Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
7026pipeline hazard recognizer.  We try quickly and easy many insn
7027schedules to choose the best one.
7028
7029The default is no multipass scheduling.
7030@end deftypefn
7031
7032@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{ready_index})
7033
7034This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
7035considered for the multipass insn scheduling.  If the hook returns
7036zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be considered in multipass scheduling.
7037Positive return values will remove @var{insn} from consideration on
7038the current round of multipass scheduling.
7039Negative return values will remove @var{insn} from consideration for given
7040number of cycles.
7041Backends should be careful about returning non-zero for highest priority
7042instruction at position 0 in the ready list.  @var{ready_index} is passed
7043to allow backends make correct judgements.
7044
7045The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
7046@end deftypefn
7047
7048@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN (void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, bool @var{first_cycle_insn_p})
7049This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
7050scheduling.
7051@end deftypefn
7052
7053@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE (void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, const void *@var{prev_data})
7054This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
7055@end deftypefn
7056
7057@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK (const void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready})
7058This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
7059an instruction.
7060@end deftypefn
7061
7062@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END (const void *@var{data})
7063This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
7064round of multipass scheduling.
7065@end deftypefn
7066
7067@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT (void *@var{data})
7068This hook initializes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
7069@end deftypefn
7070
7071@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI (void *@var{data})
7072This hook finalizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
7073@end deftypefn
7074
7075@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE (FILE *@var{dump}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{last_clock}, int @var{clock}, int *@var{sort_p})
7076This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
7077on cycle @var{clock}.  If the hook returns nonzero,
7078@var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle.  Instead,
7079the processor cycle is advanced.  If *@var{sort_p}
7080is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
7081start as usually.  @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
7082verbosity level to use for debugging output.
7083@var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
7084processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
7085and the current processor cycle.
7086@end deftypefn
7087
7088@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE (struct _dep *@var{_dep}, int @var{cost}, int @var{distance})
7089This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
7090the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
7091are involved in the dependence too close to one another.  The parameters
7092to this hook are as follows:  The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
7093being evaluated.  The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
7094dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
7095parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
7096The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
7097insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
7098and @code{false} otherwise.
7099
7100Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
7101where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
7102delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
7103that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
7104important.  In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
7105closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance;  however,
7106not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
7107@end deftypefn
7108
7109@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED (void)
7110This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
7111the instruction stream.  The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
7112per instruction data structures.
7113@end deftypefn
7114
7115@deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT (void)
7116Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
7117@end deftypefn
7118
7119@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc}, bool @var{clean_p})
7120Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
7121It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
7122beginning of the block.  Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
7123@end deftypefn
7124
7125@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
7126Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
7127@end deftypefn
7128
7129@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
7130Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
7131@end deftypefn
7132
7133@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
7134Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
7135@end deftypefn
7136
7137@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, unsigned int @var{dep_status}, rtx *@var{new_pat})
7138This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
7139speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
7140The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
7141version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
7142pattern.  The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
7143or @minus{}1, if it doesn't.  @var{request} describes the type of requested
7144speculation.  If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
7145the generated speculative pattern.
7146@end deftypefn
7147
7148@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P (unsigned int @var{dep_status})
7149This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
7150for @var{insn}.  It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
7151instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
7152@end deftypefn
7153
7154@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx_insn *@var{label}, unsigned int @var{ds})
7155This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
7156check instruction.  If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
7157speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
7158@var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
7159be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
7160recovery code (a simple check).  If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
7161a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
7162@var{insn} should be generated.  In this case @var{label} can't be null.
7163@end deftypefn
7164
7165@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS (struct spec_info_def *@var{spec_info})
7166This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
7167enabled/used.
7168The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
7169The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
7170@end deftypefn
7171
7172@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_CAN_SPECULATE_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn})
7173Some instructions should never be speculated by the schedulers, usually
7174 because the instruction is too expensive to get this wrong.  Often such
7175 instructions have long latency, and often they are not fully modeled in the
7176 pipeline descriptions.  This hook should return @code{false} if @var{insn}
7177 should not be speculated.
7178@end deftypefn
7179
7180@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII (struct ddg *@var{g})
7181This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
7182resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
7183the machine and the resources required by each instruction.  The target
7184backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound.  A very simple lower
7185bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
7186of instructions divided by the issue rate.
7187@end deftypefn
7188
7189@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{x})
7190This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler.  It returns true if dispatch scheduling
7191is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
7192@end deftypefn
7193
7194@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{x})
7195This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler.  It performs the operation specified
7196in its second parameter.
7197@end deftypefn
7198
7199@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_EXPOSED_PIPELINE
7200True if the processor has an exposed pipeline, which means that not just
7201the order of instructions is important for correctness when scheduling, but
7202also the latencies of operations.
7203@end deftypevr
7204
7205@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REASSOCIATION_WIDTH (unsigned int @var{opc}, machine_mode @var{mode})
7206This hook is called by tree reassociator to determine a level of
7207parallelism required in output calculations chain.
7208@end deftypefn
7209
7210@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FUSION_PRIORITY (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{max_pri}, int *@var{fusion_pri}, int *@var{pri})
7211This hook is called by scheduling fusion pass.  It calculates fusion
7212priorities for each instruction passed in by parameter.  The priorities
7213are returned via pointer parameters.
7214
7215@var{insn} is the instruction whose priorities need to be calculated.
7216@var{max_pri} is the maximum priority can be returned in any cases.
7217@var{fusion_pri} is the pointer parameter through which @var{insn}'s
7218fusion priority should be calculated and returned.
7219@var{pri} is the pointer parameter through which @var{insn}'s priority
7220should be calculated and returned.
7221
7222Same @var{fusion_pri} should be returned for instructions which should
7223be scheduled together.  Different @var{pri} should be returned for
7224instructions with same @var{fusion_pri}.  @var{fusion_pri} is the major
7225sort key, @var{pri} is the minor sort key.  All instructions will be
7226scheduled according to the two priorities.  All priorities calculated
7227should be between 0 (exclusive) and @var{max_pri} (inclusive).  To avoid
7228false dependencies, @var{fusion_pri} of instructions which need to be
7229scheduled together should be smaller than @var{fusion_pri} of irrelevant
7230instructions.
7231
7232Given below example:
7233
7234@smallexample
7235    ldr r10, [r1, 4]
7236    add r4, r4, r10
7237    ldr r15, [r2, 8]
7238    sub r5, r5, r15
7239    ldr r11, [r1, 0]
7240    add r4, r4, r11
7241    ldr r16, [r2, 12]
7242    sub r5, r5, r16
7243@end smallexample
7244
7245On targets like ARM/AArch64, the two pairs of consecutive loads should be
7246merged.  Since peephole2 pass can't help in this case unless consecutive
7247loads are actually next to each other in instruction flow.  That's where
7248this scheduling fusion pass works.  This hook calculates priority for each
7249instruction based on its fustion type, like:
7250
7251@smallexample
7252    ldr r10, [r1, 4]  ; fusion_pri=99,  pri=96
7253    add r4, r4, r10   ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
7254    ldr r15, [r2, 8]  ; fusion_pri=98,  pri=92
7255    sub r5, r5, r15   ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
7256    ldr r11, [r1, 0]  ; fusion_pri=99,  pri=100
7257    add r4, r4, r11   ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
7258    ldr r16, [r2, 12] ; fusion_pri=98,  pri=88
7259    sub r5, r5, r16   ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
7260@end smallexample
7261
7262Scheduling fusion pass then sorts all ready to issue instructions according
7263to the priorities.  As a result, instructions of same fusion type will be
7264pushed together in instruction flow, like:
7265
7266@smallexample
7267    ldr r11, [r1, 0]
7268    ldr r10, [r1, 4]
7269    ldr r15, [r2, 8]
7270    ldr r16, [r2, 12]
7271    add r4, r4, r10
7272    sub r5, r5, r15
7273    add r4, r4, r11
7274    sub r5, r5, r16
7275@end smallexample
7276
7277Now peephole2 pass can simply merge the two pairs of loads.
7278
7279Since scheduling fusion pass relies on peephole2 to do real fusion
7280work, it is only enabled by default when peephole2 is in effect.
7281
7282This is firstly introduced on ARM/AArch64 targets, please refer to
7283the hook implementation for how different fusion types are supported.
7284@end deftypefn
7285
7286@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXPAND_DIVMOD_LIBFUNC (rtx @var{libfunc}, machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{op0}, rtx @var{op1}, rtx *@var{quot}, rtx *@var{rem})
7287Define this hook for enabling divmod transform if the port does not have
7288hardware divmod insn but defines target-specific divmod libfuncs.
7289@end deftypefn
7290
7291@node Sections
7292@section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
7293@c the above section title is WAY too long.  maybe cut the part between
7294@c the (...)?  --mew 10feb93
7295
7296An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
7297data.  In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
7298section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
7299section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
7300section}, which holds uninitialized data.  Some systems have other kinds
7301of sections.
7302
7303@file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
7304@code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
7305The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
7306is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
7307as described below.  The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
7308initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
7309They may however depend on command-line flags.
7310
7311@emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
7312use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
7313to be string literals.
7314
7315Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
7316section is selected.  If your assembler falls into this category, you
7317should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
7318@code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
7319
7320You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
7321@code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
7322in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}.  The same is true of
7323@code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}.  If you do not
7324create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
7325reuse @code{text_section}.
7326
7327All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
7328if the target does not provide them.
7329
7330@defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
7331A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
7332assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
7333Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
7334@end defmac
7335
7336@defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
7337If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
7338frequently executed functions of the program.  If not defined, GCC will provide
7339a default definition if the target supports named sections.
7340@end defmac
7341
7342@defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
7343If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
7344executed functions in the program.
7345@end defmac
7346
7347@defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
7348A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
7349assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
7350data.  Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
7351@end defmac
7352
7353@defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
7354If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7355containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7356initialized, writable small data.
7357@end defmac
7358
7359@defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
7360A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
7361assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
7362data.
7363@end defmac
7364
7365@defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
7366If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7367containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7368uninitialized global data.  If not defined, and
7369@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} not defined,
7370uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
7371@option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
7372used.
7373@end defmac
7374
7375@defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
7376If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7377containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7378uninitialized, writable small data.
7379@end defmac
7380
7381@defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
7382If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
7383assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
7384common data.  The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
7385@end defmac
7386
7387@defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
7388If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
7389containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section.  The
7390default is @code{'T'}.
7391@end defmac
7392
7393@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
7394If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7395containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7396initialization code.  If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
7397not exist.  This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
7398variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
7399@end defmac
7400
7401@defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
7402If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7403containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7404finalization code.  If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
7405not exist.  This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
7406variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
7407@end defmac
7408
7409@defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
7410If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7411containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7412part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section.  If not
7413defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist.  Do not define
7414both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
7415@end defmac
7416
7417@defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
7418If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7419containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7420part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section.  If not
7421defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist.  Do not define
7422both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
7423@end defmac
7424
7425@defmac MACH_DEP_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
7426If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
7427containing the flag used to mark a machine-dependent section.  This
7428corresponds to the @code{SECTION_MACH_DEP} section flag.
7429@end defmac
7430
7431@defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
7432If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
7433via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
7434the text section.  This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
7435@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
7436to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
7437sections.  By default, this macro uses a simple function call.  Some
7438ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
7439registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
7440constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
7441@end defmac
7442
7443@defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
7444If defined, a string which names the section into which small
7445variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go.  This is useful
7446when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
7447you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
7448they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
7449expects.  For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
7450MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
7451require small data support from your application, but use this macro
7452to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
7453access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
7454@end defmac
7455
7456@defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
7457If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
7458arbitrary boundary.  This is used to force all fragments of the
7459@code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
7460and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
7461@end defmac
7462
7463@defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
7464Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
7465tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
7466section, along with the assembler instructions.  Otherwise, the
7467readonly data section is used.
7468
7469This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
7470@end defmac
7471
7472@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS (void)
7473Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
7474@file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
7475of its own that you need to create.
7476
7477GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
7478any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
7479described below.
7480@end deftypefn
7481
7482@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK (void)
7483Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
7484selecting sections.  Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
7485should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
7486local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
7487
7488The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
7489is in effect, and 0 otherwise.  The hook is typically redefined
7490when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
7491in read-only sections even in executables.
7492@end deftypefn
7493
7494@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION (tree @var{exp}, int @var{reloc}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7495Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed.  You can
7496assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
7497some sort.  @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
7498requires link-time relocations.  Bit 0 is set when variable contains
7499local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
7500@var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
7501
7502The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
7503variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7504
7505See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
7506@end deftypefn
7507
7508@defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
7509Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
7510for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
7511
7512In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
7513function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
7514it is unlikely to be called.
7515@end defmac
7516
7517@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, int @var{reloc})
7518Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
7519and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7520As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
7521the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
7522
7523The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
7524ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol.  For
7525example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
7526Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
7527@end deftypefn
7528
7529@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION (tree @var{decl})
7530Return the readonly data section associated with
7531@samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7532The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
7533the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
7534if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
7535otherwise.
7536@end deftypefn
7537
7538@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_MERGEABLE_RODATA_PREFIX
7539Usually, the compiler uses the prefix @code{".rodata"} to construct
7540section names for mergeable constant data.  Define this macro to override
7541the string if a different section name should be used.
7542@end deftypevr
7543
7544@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_TM_CLONE_TABLE_SECTION (void)
7545Return the section that should be used for transactional memory clone  tables.
7546@end deftypefn
7547
7548@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7549Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7550should be placed.  You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
7551constant in RTL@.  The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
7552case of a @code{const_int} rtx.  @var{align} is the constant alignment
7553in bits.
7554
7555The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7556constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7557else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7558@end deftypefn
7559
7560@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{id})
7561Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7562by target-independent code.  The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7563the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7564or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++).  The return value of the
7565hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7566your target system.  The default implementation of this hook just
7567returns the @var{id} provided.
7568@end deftypefn
7569
7570@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (tree @var{decl}, rtx @var{rtl}, int @var{new_decl_p})
7571Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7572treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7573function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7574
7575The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7576@var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7577an entry in the constant pool.  In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7578rtl in question.  Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
7579in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
7580
7581In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7582a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}.  Most decls
7583will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed.  Global
7584register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7585rtl.  (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7586leave it alone.)
7587
7588The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7589that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl.  It will
7590be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7591declarations.  Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7592declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7593@var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7594
7595@cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7596The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7597@code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7598Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7599encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7600discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7601
7602The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7603in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7604@code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.  Check whether the default does what you need
7605before overriding it.
7606@end deftypefn
7607
7608@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (const char *@var{name})
7609Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7610the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7611may have added.
7612@end deftypefn
7613
7614@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7615Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7616The default version of this hook always returns false.
7617@end deftypefn
7618
7619@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7620Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7621``small data'' into a separate section.  The default value is false.
7622@end deftypevr
7623
7624@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE (void)
7625It returns true if target wants profile code emitted before prologue.
7626
7627The default version of this hook use the target macro
7628@code{PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE}.
7629@end deftypefn
7630
7631@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7632Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7633rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7634or executable image).
7635
7636The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7637for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7638currently supported object file formats.
7639@end deftypefn
7640
7641@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7642Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7643The default value is false.
7644@end deftypevr
7645
7646
7647@node PIC
7648@section Position Independent Code
7649@cindex position independent code
7650@cindex PIC
7651
7652This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7653independent code.  Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7654generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7655@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7656@code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}.  You
7657must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7658when the source operand contains a symbolic address.  You may also
7659need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7660relative addresses.
7661@c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
7662@c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7663
7664@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7665The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7666data addresses in memory.  In some cases this register is defined by a
7667processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@.  When this macro
7668is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7669pointer and frame pointer registers.  If this macro is not defined, it
7670is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7671necessary).  Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7672when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7673@end defmac
7674
7675@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
7676A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7677@code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls.  If not defined,
7678the default is zero.  Do not define
7679this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7680@end defmac
7681
7682@defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7683A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7684operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7685You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7686check this.  You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7687check it either.  You need not define this macro if all constants
7688(including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7689position independent code.
7690@end defmac
7691
7692@node Assembler Format
7693@section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7694
7695This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7696to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7697instructions do.
7698
7699@menu
7700* File Framework::       Structural information for the assembler file.
7701* Data Output::          Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7702* Uninitialized Data::   Output of uninitialized variables.
7703* Label Output::         Output and generation of labels.
7704* Initialization::       General principles of initialization
7705                         and termination routines.
7706* Macros for Initialization::
7707                         Specific macros that control the handling of
7708                         initialization and termination routines.
7709* Instruction Output::   Output of actual instructions.
7710* Dispatch Tables::      Output of jump tables.
7711* Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7712* Alignment Output::     Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7713@end menu
7714
7715@node File Framework
7716@subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7717@cindex assembler format
7718@cindex output of assembler code
7719
7720@c prevent bad page break with this line
7721This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7722
7723@findex default_file_start
7724@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_START (void)
7725Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7726find at the beginning of a file.  The default behavior is controlled
7727by two flags, documented below.  Unless your target's assembler is
7728quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7729@code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook.  This
7730lets other target files rely on these variables.
7731@end deftypefn
7732
7733@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7734If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7735printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7736@option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect.  (If that macro has been defined
7737to the empty string, this variable has no effect.)  With the normal
7738definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7739assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7740whitespace from its input.  This allows it to work a bit faster.
7741
7742The default is false.  You should not set it to true unless you have
7743verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7744comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7745@end deftypevr
7746
7747@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7748If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7749for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7750@code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled).  Most ELF assemblers expect
7751this to be done.  The default is false.
7752@end deftypevr
7753
7754@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_END (void)
7755Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7756to find at the end of a file.  The default is to output nothing.
7757@end deftypefn
7758
7759@deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7760Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7761special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7762the stack being executable.  If your system uses this convention, you
7763should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function.  If you
7764need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7765this function.
7766@end deftypefun
7767
7768@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_START (void)
7769Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7770to find at the start of an LTO section.  The default is to output
7771nothing.
7772@end deftypefn
7773
7774@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_END (void)
7775Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7776to find at the end of an LTO section.  The default is to output
7777nothing.
7778@end deftypefn
7779
7780@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CODE_END (void)
7781Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7782unwind info and debug info at the end of a file.  Some targets emit
7783here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7784because they couldn't have unwind info then.  The default is to output
7785nothing.
7786@end deftypefn
7787
7788@defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7789A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7790assembler language.  The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7791the end of the line.
7792@end defmac
7793
7794@defmac ASM_APP_ON
7795A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7796statement or group of consecutive ones.  Normally this is
7797@code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7798assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7799that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7800@end defmac
7801
7802@defmac ASM_APP_OFF
7803A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7804statement or group of consecutive ones.  Normally this is
7805@code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7806time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7807@end defmac
7808
7809@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7810A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7811which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7812the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7813
7814This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7815for the file format in use is appropriate.
7816@end defmac
7817
7818@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name})
7819Output DWARF debugging information which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to the stdio stream @var{file}.
7820
7821 This target hook need not be defined if the standard form of output for the file format in use is appropriate.
7822@end deftypefn
7823
7824@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (const char *@var{name})
7825Output a string based on @var{name}, suitable for the @samp{#ident}  directive, or the equivalent directive or pragma in non-C-family languages.  If this hook is not defined, nothing is output for the @samp{#ident}  directive.
7826@end deftypefn
7827
7828@defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7829A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7830@var{stream}.  If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
7831in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
7832the assembler source.  So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7833of the filename using this macro.
7834@end defmac
7835
7836@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION (const char *@var{name}, unsigned int @var{flags}, tree @var{decl})
7837Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}.  The section
7838should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
7839of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}.  If @var{decl}
7840is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7841this section is associated.
7842@end deftypefn
7843
7844@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_ELF_FLAGS_NUMERIC (unsigned int @var{flags}, unsigned int *@var{num})
7845This hook can be used to encode ELF section flags for which no letter
7846code has been defined in the assembler.  It is called by
7847@code{default_asm_named_section} whenever the section flags need to be
7848emitted in the assembler output.  If the hook returns true, then the
7849numerical value for ELF section flags should be calculated from
7850@var{flags} and saved in @var{*num}; the value is printed out instead of the
7851normal sequence of letter codes.  If the hook is not defined, or if it
7852returns false, then @var{num} is ignored and the traditional letter sequence
7853is emitted.
7854@end deftypefn
7855
7856@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, enum node_frequency @var{freq}, bool @var{startup}, bool @var{exit})
7857Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}.
7858Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot
7859functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only
7860at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}).
7861@var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit
7862(from static destructors).
7863Return NULL if function should go to default text section.
7864@end deftypefn
7865
7866@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SWITCHED_TEXT_SECTIONS (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{decl}, bool @var{new_is_cold})
7867Used by the target to emit any assembler directives or additional  labels needed when a function is partitioned between different  sections.  Output should be written to @var{file}.  The function  decl is available as @var{decl} and the new section is `cold' if  @var{new_is_cold} is @code{true}.
7868@end deftypefn
7869
7870@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7871This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
7872It must not be modified by command-line option processing.
7873@end deftypevr
7874
7875@anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
7876@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
7877This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7878section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7879This is true on most ELF targets.
7880@end deftypevr
7881
7882@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{name}, int @var{reloc})
7883Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7884based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7885declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations.  @var{decl} may be
7886null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7887
7888The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7889read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}.  You should only
7890need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7891set via @code{__attribute__}.
7892@end deftypefn
7893
7894@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES (print_switch_type @var{type}, const char *@var{text})
7895Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7896switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7897enabled.  The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7898It can take the following values:
7899
7900@table @gcctabopt
7901@item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7902@var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7903
7904@item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7905@var{text} is an option which has been enabled.  This might be as a
7906direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7907default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7908command line switch.  For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7909various different individual optimization passes.
7910
7911@item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7912@var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7913ignored.  If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7914target hook that either recording is starting or ending.  The first
7915time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7916warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7917wind down.  This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7918necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7919perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7920switches.
7921
7922@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7923This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7924
7925@item  SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7926This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7927@end table
7928
7929The hook's return value must be zero.  Other return values may be
7930supported in the future.
7931
7932By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7933provided for ELF based targets.  Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7934it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7935section in the assembler output file.  The name of the new section is
7936provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7937hook.
7938@end deftypefn
7939
7940@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
7941This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7942ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7943hook.
7944@end deftypevr
7945
7946@need 2000
7947@node Data Output
7948@subsection Output of Data
7949
7950
7951@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7952@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7953@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7954@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7955@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7956@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7957@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7958@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7959@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7960These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7961of integer object.  The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7962byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7963aligned two-byte object, and so on.  Any of the hooks may be
7964@code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7965
7966The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7967followed immediately by the object's initial value.  In most cases,
7968the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7969@end deftypevr
7970
7971@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_INTEGER (rtx @var{x}, unsigned int @var{size}, int @var{aligned_p})
7972The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7973integer object.  @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7974in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned.  The
7975function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7976object.  If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7977split the object into smaller parts.
7978
7979The default implementation of this hook will use the
7980@code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7981when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7982@end deftypefn
7983
7984@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECL_END (void)
7985Define this hook if the target assembler requires a special marker to
7986terminate an initialized variable declaration.
7987@end deftypefn
7988
7989@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{x})
7990A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7991can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7992the pattern @var{x}.  This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7993@code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7994
7995If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7996so that a standard error message is printed.  If it prints an error message
7997itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7998return @code{true}.
7999@end deftypefn
8000
8001@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
8002A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8003instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
8004bytes at @var{ptr}.  @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
8005@code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
8006
8007If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
8008Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
8009@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
8010@end defmac
8011
8012@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
8013A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
8014@var{decl}.  This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
8015is defined, and is otherwise unused.
8016@end defmac
8017
8018@defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
8019You may define this macro as a C expression.  You should define the
8020expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
8021pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
8022GCC should output the constant pool after the function.  If you do
8023not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
8024pool before the function.
8025@end defmac
8026
8027@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
8028A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
8029constant pool for a function.  @var{funname} is a string giving
8030the name of the function.  Should the return type of the function
8031be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}.  @var{size}
8032is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
8033immediately after this call.
8034
8035If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
8036not be defined.
8037@end defmac
8038
8039@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
8040A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
8041constant pool, if it needs special treatment.  (This macro need not do
8042anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
8043
8044The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
8045assembler code on.  @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
8046output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
8047@samp{const_int}).  @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
8048@var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
8049alignment.
8050
8051The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
8052the address of this pool entry.  The definition of this macro is
8053responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
8054Here is how to do this:
8055
8056@smallexample
8057@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
8058@end smallexample
8059
8060When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
8061@code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}.  This will prevent the same pool
8062entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
8063
8064You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
8065@end defmac
8066
8067@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
8068A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
8069pool for a function.  @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
8070function.  Should the return type of the function be required, you can
8071obtain it via @var{fundecl}.  @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
8072constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
8073
8074If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
8075define this macro.
8076@end defmac
8077
8078@defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
8079Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
8080used as a logical line separator by the assembler.  @var{STR} points
8081to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
8082a line separator uses multiple characters.
8083
8084If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
8085the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
8086@end defmac
8087
8088@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
8089@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
8090These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
8091assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions.  If not overridden, they
8092default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
8093@end deftypevr
8094
8095These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
8096of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
8097
8098@defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
8099@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
8100@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
8101@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
8102@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
8103@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
8104These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
8105target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
8106the variable @var{l}.  For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
8107@code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
8108simple @code{long int}.  For the others, it should be an array of
8109@code{long int}.  The number of elements in this array is determined
8110by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
8111it go in each @code{long int} array element.  Each array element holds
811232 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
8113on the host machine.
8114
8115The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
8116using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
8117machine's memory.
8118@end defmac
8119
8120@node Uninitialized Data
8121@subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
8122
8123Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
8124outputting a single uninitialized variable.
8125
8126@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
8127A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8128@var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
8129@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes.  The variable @var{rounded}
8130is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.  It is
8131possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
8132other member than a zero-length array is defined.  In this case, the
8133backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
8134byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
8135equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
8136the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
8137an ordinary undefined external.
8138
8139Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
8140output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
8141assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
8142
8143This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
8144common global variables are output.
8145@end defmac
8146
8147@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
8148Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
8149separate, explicit argument.  If you define this macro, it is used in
8150place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
8151handling the required alignment of the variable.  The alignment is specified
8152as the number of bits.
8153@end defmac
8154
8155@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
8156Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
8157variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
8158is no corresponding variable.  If you define this macro, GCC will use it
8159in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
8160@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}.  Define this macro when you need to see
8161the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
8162@end defmac
8163
8164@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
8165A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8166@var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
8167@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes.  The variable @var{alignment}
8168is the alignment specified as the number of bits.
8169
8170Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
8171@file{varasm.c} when defining this macro.  If unable, use the expression
8172@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
8173before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
8174the name, and a newline.
8175
8176There are two ways of handling global BSS@.  One is to define this macro.
8177The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
8178switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
8179You do not need to do both.
8180
8181Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
8182non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
8183efficiently.  C++ is one example of this.  However, if the target does
8184not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
8185common in order to save space in the object file.
8186@end defmac
8187
8188@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
8189A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8190@var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
8191@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes.  The variable @var{rounded}
8192is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
8193
8194Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
8195output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
8196assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
8197
8198This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
8199static variables are output.
8200@end defmac
8201
8202@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
8203Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
8204separate, explicit argument.  If you define this macro, it is used in
8205place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
8206handling the required alignment of the variable.  The alignment is specified
8207as the number of bits.
8208@end defmac
8209
8210@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
8211Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
8212variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
8213is no corresponding variable.  If you define this macro, GCC will use it
8214in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
8215@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}.  Define this macro when you need to see
8216the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
8217@end defmac
8218
8219@node Label Output
8220@subsection Output and Generation of Labels
8221
8222@c prevent bad page break with this line
8223This is about outputting labels.
8224
8225@findex assemble_name
8226@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8227A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8228@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
8229Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
8230output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
8231assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.  A default
8232definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
8233@end defmac
8234
8235@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8236A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8237@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
8238a function.
8239Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
8240output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
8241assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.  A default
8242definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
8243
8244If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
8245usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
8246@end defmac
8247
8248@findex assemble_name_raw
8249@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8250Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
8251to refer to a compiler-generated label.  The default definition uses
8252@code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
8253that it is more efficient.
8254@end defmac
8255
8256@defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
8257A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
8258size of a symbol, without any arguments.  On systems that use ELF, the
8259default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
8260systems, the default is not to define this macro.
8261
8262Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
8263of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
8264for your system.  If you need your own custom definitions of those
8265macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
8266define this macro.
8267@end defmac
8268
8269@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
8270A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8271@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
8272symbol @var{name} is @var{size}.  @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
8273If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
8274provided.
8275@end defmac
8276
8277@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8278A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8279@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
8280the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
8281address.
8282
8283If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
8284provided.  The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
8285@samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
8286the difference between this and another symbol.  If your assembler does
8287not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
8288to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
8289@end defmac
8290
8291@defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
8292Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
8293@samp{$} in label names.  By default constructors and destructors in
8294G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers.  If this macro is defined,
8295@samp{.} is used instead.
8296@end defmac
8297
8298@defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
8299Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
8300@samp{.} in label names.  By default constructors and destructors in G++
8301have names that use @samp{.}.  If this macro is defined, these names
8302are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
8303@end defmac
8304
8305@defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
8306A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
8307type of a symbol, without any arguments.  On systems that use ELF, the
8308default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
8309systems, the default is not to define this macro.
8310
8311Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
8312@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system.  If you need your own
8313custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
8314types at all, do not define this macro.
8315@end defmac
8316
8317@defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
8318A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
8319the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}.  On systems that use ELF, the
8320default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
8321the default is not to define this macro.
8322
8323Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
8324@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system.  If you need your own
8325custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
8326types at all, do not define this macro.
8327@end defmac
8328
8329@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
8330A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8331@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
8332symbol @var{name} is @var{type}.  @var{type} is a C string; currently,
8333that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
8334you should not count on this.
8335
8336If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
8337definition of this macro is provided.
8338@end defmac
8339
8340@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8341A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8342@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
8343function which is being defined.  This macro is responsible for
8344outputting the label definition (perhaps using
8345@code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).  The argument @var{decl} is the
8346@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
8347
8348If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
8349usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
8350
8351You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
8352of this macro.
8353@end defmac
8354
8355@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8356A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8357@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
8358which is being defined.  The argument @var{name} is the name of the
8359function.  The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
8360representing the function.
8361
8362If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
8363
8364You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
8365of this macro.
8366@end defmac
8367
8368@defmac ASM_DECLARE_COLD_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8369A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8370@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
8371cold function partition which is being defined.  This macro is responsible
8372for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
8373@code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).  The argument @var{decl} is the
8374@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
8375
8376If this macro is not defined, then the cold partition name is defined in the
8377usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
8378
8379You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
8380of this macro.
8381@end defmac
8382
8383@defmac ASM_DECLARE_COLD_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8384A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8385@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a cold function
8386partition which is being defined.  The argument @var{name} is the name of the
8387cold partition of the function.  The argument @var{decl} is the
8388@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
8389
8390If this macro is not defined, then the partition size is not defined.
8391
8392You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
8393of this macro.
8394@end defmac
8395
8396@defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8397A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8398@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
8399initialized variable which is being defined.  This macro must output the
8400label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).  The argument
8401@var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
8402
8403If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
8404usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
8405
8406You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
8407@code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
8408@end defmac
8409
8410@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{expr}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
8411A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
8412for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined.  This
8413target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
8414@code{assemble_label}).  The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
8415and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes.  The @var{name}
8416will be an internal label.
8417
8418The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
8419usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
8420
8421You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
8422@end deftypefn
8423
8424@defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
8425A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8426@var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
8427for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
8428
8429If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
8430nothing.
8431@end defmac
8432
8433@defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
8434A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
8435once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
8436chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
8437initializer.  This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
8438something about the size of the object.
8439
8440If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
8441nothing.
8442
8443You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
8444@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
8445@end defmac
8446
8447@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name})
8448This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8449@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
8450that is, available for reference from other files.
8451
8452The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
8453@code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
8454@end deftypefn
8455
8456@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl})
8457This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8458@var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
8459global; that is, available for reference from other files.
8460
8461The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
8462@end deftypefn
8463
8464@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_UNDEFINED_DECL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{decl})
8465This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8466@var{stream} some commands that will declare the name associated with
8467@var{decl} which is not defined in the current translation unit.  Most
8468assemblers do not require anything to be output in this case.
8469@end deftypefn
8470
8471@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8472A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8473@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
8474that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
8475no other definition is available.  Use the expression
8476@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
8477itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
8478for making that name weak, and a newline.
8479
8480If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
8481support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
8482macro.
8483@end defmac
8484
8485@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8486Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
8487@code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
8488or variable decl.  If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
8489should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
8490defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8491@var{value}.  If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
8492to make @var{name} weak.
8493@end defmac
8494
8495@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8496Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
8497symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics.  @code{decl} is the
8498declaration of @code{name}.
8499@end defmac
8500
8501@defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
8502A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
8503supports weak symbols.
8504
8505If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8506definition.  If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
8507is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
8508@end defmac
8509
8510@defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
8511A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
8512
8513If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8514definition.  The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}.  Define
8515this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
8516flag such as @option{-melf}.
8517@end defmac
8518
8519@defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
8520A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
8521public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
8522be discarded by the linker.  Define this macro if your object file
8523format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
8524section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
8525requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
8526@end defmac
8527
8528@defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
8529A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
8530semantics.
8531
8532If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
8533definition.  If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
8534definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.  Define this macro if
8535you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
8536setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
8537be emitted as one-only.
8538@end defmac
8539
8540@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl}, int @var{visibility})
8541This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
8542commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
8543hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
8544@end deftypefn
8545
8546@defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
8547A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
8548that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
8549The default is @code{0}.
8550
8551Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
8552if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
8553will have undefined references from other translation units, that
8554symbol should not be weak.  Defining this macro to be nonzero will
8555thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
8556(explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
8557with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
8558
8559The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero.  Define this macro for
8560targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
8561restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
8562table of contents.
8563@end defmac
8564
8565@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
8566A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8567@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
8568symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
8569not defined.  The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
8570declaration.
8571
8572This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
8573The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
8574@end defmac
8575
8576@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (rtx @var{symref})
8577This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8578pseudo-op to declare a library function name external.  The name of the
8579library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
8580@end deftypefn
8581
8582@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED (const char *@var{symbol})
8583This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8584directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used.  The Darwin target uses the
8585.no_dead_code_strip directive.
8586@end deftypefn
8587
8588@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8589A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8590@var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
8591@var{name}.  This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
8592is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
8593systems.  This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
8594@end defmac
8595
8596@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_ASSEMBLER_NAME (const char *@var{name})
8597Given a symbol @var{name}, perform same mangling as @code{varasm.c}'s @code{assemble_name}, but in memory rather than to a file stream, returning result as an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE}.  Required for correct LTO symtabs.  The default implementation calls the @code{TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING} hook and then prepends the @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX}, if any.
8598@end deftypefn
8599
8600@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
8601A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
8602@code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}.  If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
8603will be used to output the name of the symbol.  This macro may be used
8604to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
8605encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
8606@end defmac
8607
8608@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
8609A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
8610result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.  If not defined,
8611@code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
8612This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
8613specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
8614when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
8615being taken.
8616@end defmac
8617
8618@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{prefix}, unsigned long @var{labelno})
8619A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
8620name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
8621
8622It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8623used for user-level functions and variables.  Otherwise, certain programs
8624will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8625
8626It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8627object file.  Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8628should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8629beginning of a label has this effect.  You should find out what
8630convention your system uses, and follow it.
8631
8632The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
8633@end deftypefn
8634
8635@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8636A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8637label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8638@var{num}.  This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8639may need to be treated differently than branch target labels.  On some
8640systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8641bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8642bundles.
8643
8644If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8645used.
8646@end defmac
8647
8648@defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8649A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8650is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8651
8652This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8653produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8654with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8655
8656If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8657output the rest of the string unchanged.  It is often convenient for
8658@code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way.  If the
8659string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8660to output the string, and may change it.  (Of course,
8661@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8662you should know what it does on your machine.)
8663@end defmac
8664
8665@defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8666A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8667@code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8668@var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8669added.  Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8670
8671The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8672produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8673@var{name}.  Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8674assembler code.  The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8675macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8676internal static variables in different scopes.
8677
8678Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8679conflict with the user's own symbols.  Most assemblers allow periods
8680or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8681between the name and the number will suffice.
8682
8683If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8684which is correct for most systems.
8685@end defmac
8686
8687@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8688A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8689which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8690
8691@findex SET_ASM_OP
8692If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8693correct for most systems.
8694@end defmac
8695
8696@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8697A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8698which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8699to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}.  This macro will
8700be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8701the tree nodes are available.
8702
8703@findex SET_ASM_OP
8704If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8705correct for most systems.
8706@end defmac
8707
8708@defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8709A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8710(equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8711of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8712current compilation unit.  The default is to not defer output of defines.
8713This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8714@samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8715@end defmac
8716
8717@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8718A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8719which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8720@var{value}.  If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8721an undefined weak symbol.
8722
8723Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8724@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8725@end defmac
8726
8727@defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8728Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8729Objective-C methods.
8730
8731The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8732class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}).  For methods in categories, the name of
8733the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8734@samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8735
8736These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8737the method's selector is not present in the name.  Therefore, particular
8738systems define other ways of computing names.
8739
8740@var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8741buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8742@var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
874350 characters extra.
8744
8745The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8746method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8747@var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8748in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8749
8750On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8751macro to provide more human-readable names.
8752@end defmac
8753
8754@node Initialization
8755@subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8756@cindex initialization routines
8757@cindex termination routines
8758@cindex constructors, output of
8759@cindex destructors, output of
8760
8761The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8762(also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8763data in the program when the program is started.  These functions need
8764to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8765@code{main} is called.
8766
8767Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8768@dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8769terminates.
8770
8771To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8772must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8773be called at the appropriate time.  When you port the compiler to a new
8774system, you need to specify how to do this.
8775
8776There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8777initialization and termination functions.  Each way has two variants.
8778Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8779
8780@findex __CTOR_LIST__
8781@findex __DTOR_LIST__
8782The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8783initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8784termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8785
8786Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
87870, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8788the environment).  This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8789pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8790pointer containing zero.
8791
8792Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8793@file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8794time and exit time.  Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8795list; destructors in forward order.
8796
8797The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8798formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections.  A section is set
8799aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8800Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}.  Each
8801object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8802the constructor section to point to that function.  The linker
8803accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8804Termination functions are handled similarly.
8805
8806This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8807@code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined.  A target that does not
8808support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
8809constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8810and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
8811
8812When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8813upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called.  On systems that
8814support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
8815parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section.  The
8816program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
8817
8818@smallexample
8819ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
8820@end smallexample
8821
8822The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8823section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}.  Likewise
8824for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section.  Normally these
8825files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8826are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8827
8828The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8829compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}.  They contain, among other things, code
8830fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8831to routines in the @code{.text} section.  The linker will pull all parts
8832of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8833that invokes the routines we need at startup.
8834
8835To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8836macro properly.
8837
8838If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8839@code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8840entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8841it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8842after the function prologue.  The @code{__main} function is defined
8843in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
8844
8845In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8846two variants.  In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8847and an `a.out' format must be used.  In this case,
8848@code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
8849entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8850and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8851code as its value.  The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
8852the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
8853placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8854a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
8855@code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly.  Since no init
8856section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8857the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8858the initialization process.
8859
8860The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8861This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
8862file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@.  In
8863this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8864termination functions are recognized simply by their names.  This requires
8865an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}.  This program
8866pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8867the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8868initialization and termination functions.  These functions are called
8869via @code{__main} as described above.  In order to use this method,
8870@code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
8871
8872@ifinfo
8873The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8874customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8875@end ifinfo
8876
8877@node Macros for Initialization
8878@subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8879
8880Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8881and termination functions:
8882
8883@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
8884If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8885operation to identify the following data as initialization code.  If not
8886defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist.  When you are
8887using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8888macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8889run the initialization functions.
8890@end defmac
8891
8892@defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
8893If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
8894This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8895on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8896be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
8897@end defmac
8898
8899@defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
8900If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8901the following symbol is an initialization routine.
8902@end defmac
8903
8904@defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
8905If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8906the following symbol is a finalization routine.
8907@end defmac
8908
8909@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8910If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8911automatically called when a shared library is loaded.  The function
8912should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments.  If not defined, and
8913the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
8914function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
8915
8916This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
8917shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
8918exception tables embedded in the code.
8919@end defmac
8920
8921@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8922If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8923automatically called when a shared library is unloaded.  The function
8924should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments.  If not defined, and
8925the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
8926function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
8927@end defmac
8928
8929@defmac INVOKE__main
8930If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8931@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.  This macro should be defined for systems
8932where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8933useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
8934@end defmac
8935
8936@defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
8937If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8938compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8939of objects.  If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8940encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
8941@end defmac
8942
8943@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
8944This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8945collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8946It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
8947@end deftypevr
8948
8949@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8950If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8951the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
8952
8953Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8954no arguments and with no return value.  If the target supports initialization
8955priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8956otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8957
8958If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
8959be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8960target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8961is not defined.
8962@end deftypefn
8963
8964@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8965This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
8966functions rather than initialization functions.
8967@end deftypefn
8968
8969If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8970generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
8971
8972If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8973constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8974an object file for constructor functions to be called.
8975
8976On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
8977@command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
8978
8979@defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
8980Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
8981object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
8982object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
8983
8984This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
8985part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
8986@end defmac
8987
8988@defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
8989Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
8990to execute @command{nm}.  The default is to search the path normally for
8991@command{nm}.
8992@end defmac
8993
8994@defmac NM_FLAGS
8995@command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
8996constructors and destructors and LTO info.  By default, @option{-n} is
8997passed.  Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
8998are needed to get the same output format as GNU @command{nm -n}
8999produces.
9000@end defmac
9001
9002If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
9003dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
9004these macros to enable support for running initialization and
9005termination functions in shared libraries:
9006
9007@defmac LDD_SUFFIX
9008Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
9009which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
9010@end defmac
9011
9012@defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
9013Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
9014of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}.  @var{ptr} is a variable
9015of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
9016from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}.  If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
9017code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
9018line.  Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
9019@end defmac
9020
9021@defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
9022Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
9023library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}).  @command{collect2}
9024strips version information after this suffix when generating global
9025constructor and destructor names.  This define is only needed on targets
9026that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
9027@end defmac
9028
9029@node Instruction Output
9030@subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
9031
9032@c prevent bad page break with this line
9033This describes assembler instruction output.
9034
9035@defmac REGISTER_NAMES
9036A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
9037registers, each one as a C string constant.  This is what translates
9038register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
9039@end defmac
9040
9041@defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
9042If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
9043and a register number.  This macro defines additional names for hard
9044registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
9045to registers using alternate names.
9046@end defmac
9047
9048@defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
9049If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
9050name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
9051machine registers the name overlaps.  This macro defines additional
9052names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
9053declarations to refer to registers using alternate names.  Unlike
9054@code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
9055register name implies multiple underlying registers.
9056
9057This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
9058@code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
9059register name.  For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
9060VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
9061``s0'' and ``s1''.
9062@end defmac
9063
9064@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
9065Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
9066requires different names for the machine instructions.
9067
9068The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
9069assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}.  The
9070macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
9071points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
9072written in the machine description.  The definition should output the
9073opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
9074increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
9075so that it will not be output twice.
9076
9077In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
9078name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
9079that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
9080care of the substitution yourself.  Just be sure to increment
9081@var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
9082
9083@findex recog_data.operand
9084If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
9085elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
9086
9087If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
9088in the usual way.
9089@end defmac
9090
9091@defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
9092If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
9093assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
9094they will be output differently.
9095
9096Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
9097extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
9098elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
9099The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
9100template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
9101by changing the contents of the vector.
9102
9103This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
9104file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
9105can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
9106as with rearranged operands).  Naturally, variations in assembler
9107syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
9108writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
9109
9110If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
9111@end defmac
9112
9113@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN (FILE *@var{file}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx *@var{opvec}, int @var{noperands})
9114If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
9115output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
9116if necessary.
9117
9118Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
9119extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
9120elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
9121The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
9122template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
9123by checking the contents of the vector.
9124@end deftypefn
9125
9126@defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
9127A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
9128assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}.  @var{x} is an
9129RTL expression.
9130
9131@var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
9132of printing the operand.  It is used when identical operands must be
9133printed differently depending on the context.  @var{code} comes from
9134the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
9135operand.  If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
9136@var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
9137@var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
9138
9139@findex reg_names
9140If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
9141The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
9142@code{char *[]}.  @code{reg_names} is initialized from
9143@code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
9144
9145When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
9146(a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
9147with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
9148@var{code}.
9149@end defmac
9150
9151@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
9152A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
9153punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro.  If
9154@code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
9155punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
9156in this way.
9157@end defmac
9158
9159@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
9160A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
9161assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
9162whose address is @var{x}.  @var{x} is an RTL expression.
9163
9164@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
9165On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
9166section that the address refers to.  On these machines, define the hook
9167@code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
9168@code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here.  @xref{Assembler
9169Format}.
9170@end defmac
9171
9172@findex dbr_sequence_length
9173@defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
9174A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
9175been output.  If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
9176determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
9177currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
9178or whatever.
9179
9180Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
9181reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
9182explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
9183@end defmac
9184
9185@findex final_sequence
9186Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
9187prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
9188(i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
9189found.)  The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
9190processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
9191being output.
9192
9193@findex asm_fprintf
9194@defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
9195@defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
9196@defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
9197@defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
9198If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
9199@samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
9200@file{final.c}).  These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
9201support multiple assembler formats.  In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
9202files can define these macros differently.
9203@end defmac
9204
9205@defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
9206If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
9207statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
9208the @code{asm_fprintf} function.  This allows targets to define extra
9209printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
9210statements.  Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
9211generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
9212specific code.  The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
9213The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
9214string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
9215upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
9216@end defmac
9217
9218@defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
9219If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
9220different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
9221numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
9222first variant.
9223
9224If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
9225@smallexample
9226@samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
9227@end smallexample
9228@noindent
9229in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
9230first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}.  This construct outputs
9231@samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
9232@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc.  Any special characters
9233within these strings retain their usual meaning.  If there are fewer
9234alternatives within the braces than the value of
9235@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing. If it's needed
9236to print curly braces or @samp{|} character in assembler output directly,
9237@samp{%@{}, @samp{%@}} and @samp{%|} can be used.
9238
9239If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
9240@samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
9241operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
9242
9243Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
9244@code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
9245the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism.  Define
9246@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
9247if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
9248opcodes or operand order.
9249@end defmac
9250
9251@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
9252A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
9253which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
9254The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
9255profiling.
9256@end defmac
9257
9258@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
9259A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
9260which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
9261The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
9262profiling.
9263@end defmac
9264
9265@node Dispatch Tables
9266@subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
9267
9268@c prevent bad page break with this line
9269This concerns dispatch tables.
9270
9271@cindex dispatch table
9272@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
9273A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9274pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
9275@var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels.  The
9276definitions of these labels are output using
9277@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
9278way here.  For example,
9279
9280@smallexample
9281fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
9282         @var{value}, @var{rel})
9283@end smallexample
9284
9285You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
9286dispatch table are relative to the table's own address.  If defined, GCC
9287will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
9288@var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
9289mode and flags can be read.
9290@end defmac
9291
9292@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
9293This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
9294in a dispatch table are absolute.
9295
9296The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
9297@var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
9298a label.  @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
9299definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
9300For example,
9301
9302@smallexample
9303fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
9304@end smallexample
9305@end defmac
9306
9307@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
9308Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
9309specially.  The first three arguments are the same as for
9310@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
9311jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_table_data} containing an
9312@code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
9313
9314This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
9315for the table.
9316
9317If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
9318@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
9319@end defmac
9320
9321@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
9322Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
9323jump-table.  The definition should be a C statement to be executed
9324after the assembler code for the table is written.  It should write
9325the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}.  The argument
9326@var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
9327of the preceding label.
9328
9329If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
9330the jump-table.
9331@end defmac
9332
9333@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl}, int @var{for_eh}, int @var{empty})
9334This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@.  It
9335should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
9336should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
9337function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9338The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
9339exception table.  The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
9340true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
9341
9342The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
9343@end deftypefn
9344
9345@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream})
9346This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
9347It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
9348to be broken up according to function.
9349
9350The default is that no label is emitted.
9351@end deftypefn
9352
9353@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY (rtx @var{personality})
9354If the target implements @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT}, this hook may be used to emit a directive to install a personality hook into the unwind info.  This hook should not be used if dwarf2 unwind info is used.
9355@end deftypefn
9356
9357@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT (FILE *@var{stream}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
9358This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
9359given instruction.  This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9360returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
9361@end deftypefn
9362
9363@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
9364True if the @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT} hook should be called before the assembly for @var{insn} has been emitted, false if the hook should be called afterward.
9365@end deftypevr
9366
9367@node Exception Region Output
9368@subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
9369
9370@c prevent bad page break with this line
9371
9372This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
9373region.
9374
9375@defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
9376If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
9377exception handling frame unwind information.  If not defined, GCC will
9378provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
9379@file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
9380
9381You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
9382unwind information and the default definition does not work.
9383@end defmac
9384
9385@defmac EH_FRAME_THROUGH_COLLECT2
9386If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will identified by
9387specially named labels.  The collect2 process will locate these
9388labels and generate code to register the frames.
9389
9390This might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker will not
9391place the eh_frames in-between the sentinals from @file{crtstuff.c},
9392or if the system linker does garbage collection and sections cannot
9393be marked as not to be collected.
9394@end defmac
9395
9396@defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
9397Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
9398information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
9399runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
9400and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
9401@end defmac
9402
9403@defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
9404An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
9405that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
9406@end defmac
9407
9408@defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
9409Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
9410information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
9411Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
9412@code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}),
9413GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
9414@end defmac
9415
9416@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
9417This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
9418by the target.  If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
9419should return @code{UI_TARGET}.  If the target is to use the
9420@code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
9421should return @code{UI_SJLJ}.  If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
9422information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
9423
9424A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
9425This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code.  The
9426default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
9427
9428Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant.  It should
9429not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by
9430@var{opts}.  In particular, the
9431setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
9432macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
9433depending on this setting.
9434
9435The default implementation of the hook first honors the
9436@option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
9437@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}.  If
9438@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target
9439must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly.
9440@end deftypefn
9441
9442@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
9443This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
9444tables even when exceptions are not used.  It must not be modified by
9445command-line option processing.
9446@end deftypevr
9447
9448@defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
9449Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
9450should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
9451instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
9452@end defmac
9453
9454@defmac JMP_BUF_SIZE
9455This macro has no effect unless @code{DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP} is also
9456defined.  Define this macro if the default size of @code{jmp_buf} buffer
9457for the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism
9458is not large enough, or if it is much too large.
9459The default size is @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER * sizeof(void *)}.
9460@end defmac
9461
9462@defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
9463This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
9464function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
9465@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}.  The definition should be the negative minimum
9466alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is true, and the positive
9467minimum alignment otherwise.  @xref{DWARF}.  Only applicable if
9468the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
9469@end defmac
9470
9471@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
9472Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
9473end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
9474Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
9475true otherwise.
9476@end deftypevr
9477
9478@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN (rtx @var{reg})
9479Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
9480represent where to find the register pieces.  Define this hook if the
9481register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
9482locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
9483register in Dwarf.  Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
9484If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
9485@end deftypefn
9486
9487@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_DWARF_FRAME_REG_MODE (int @var{regno})
9488Given a register, this hook should return the mode which the
9489corresponding Dwarf frame register should have.  This is normally
9490used to return a smaller mode than the raw mode to prevent call
9491clobbered parts of a register altering the frame register size
9492@end deftypefn
9493
9494@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA (tree @var{address})
9495If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
9496multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
9497sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
9498It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
9499filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
9500@var{address} is the address of the table.
9501@end deftypefn
9502
9503@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_TTYPE (rtx @var{sym})
9504This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
9505the type_info object identified by @var{sym}.  It should return @code{true}
9506if the reference was output.  Returning @code{false} will cause the
9507reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
9508@end deftypefn
9509
9510@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
9511This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
9512based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets.  This effects
9513the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
9514running a cleanup.  The default is @code{false}.
9515@end deftypevr
9516
9517@node Alignment Output
9518@subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
9519
9520@c prevent bad page break with this line
9521This describes commands for alignment.
9522
9523@defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
9524The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
9525a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
9526
9527This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9528to be done at such a time.  Most machine descriptions do not currently
9529define the macro.
9530
9531Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9532to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
9533@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.  Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9534selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
9535@end defmac
9536
9537@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
9538The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
9539@code{JUMP_ALIGN}.  This works only if
9540@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
9541@end deftypefn
9542
9543@defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
9544The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
9545a @code{BARRIER}.
9546
9547This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9548to be done at such a time.  Most machine descriptions do not currently
9549define the macro.
9550@end defmac
9551
9552@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
9553The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
9554@code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}.  This works only if
9555@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
9556@end deftypefn
9557
9558@defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
9559The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label} that heads
9560a frequently executed basic block (usually the header of a loop).
9561
9562This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9563to be done at such a time.  Most machine descriptions do not currently
9564define the macro.
9565
9566Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9567to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
9568@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.  Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9569selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
9570@end defmac
9571
9572@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
9573The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
9574@var{label}.  This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
9575defined.
9576@end deftypefn
9577
9578@defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
9579The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
9580If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
9581the maximum of the specified values is used.
9582
9583Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9584to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
9585@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.  Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9586selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
9587@end defmac
9588
9589@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
9590The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
9591to @var{label}.  This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
9592is defined.
9593@end deftypefn
9594
9595@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
9596A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9597instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
9598Those bytes should be zero when loaded.  @var{nbytes} will be a C
9599expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
9600@end defmac
9601
9602@defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
9603Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
9604text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
9605This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
9606produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
9607section.
9608@end defmac
9609
9610@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9611A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9612command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9613@var{power} bytes.  @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
9614@end defmac
9615
9616@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9617Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
9618for padding, if necessary.
9619@end defmac
9620
9621@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
9622A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9623command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9624@var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
9625satisfy the alignment request.  @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
9626a C expression of type @code{int}.
9627@end defmac
9628
9629@need 3000
9630@node Debugging Info
9631@section Controlling Debugging Information Format
9632
9633@c prevent bad page break with this line
9634This describes how to specify debugging information.
9635
9636@menu
9637* All Debuggers::      Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9638* DBX Options::        Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9639* DBX Hooks::          Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9640* File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9641* DWARF::              Macros for DWARF format.
9642* VMS Debug::          Macros for VMS debug format.
9643@end menu
9644
9645@node All Debuggers
9646@subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9647
9648@c prevent bad page break with this line
9649These macros affect all debugging formats.
9650
9651@defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
9652A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
9653register number @var{regno}.  In the default macro provided, the value
9654of this expression will be @var{regno} itself.  But sometimes there are
9655some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9656versa.  In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9657compiler and another for DBX@.
9658
9659If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
9660used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9661consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9662Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9663expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9664
9665If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9666does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9667redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
9668@end defmac
9669
9670@defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
9671A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9672variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression).  The default
9673computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9674gives the offset from the frame-pointer.  This is required for targets
9675that produce debugging output for DBX and allow the frame-pointer to be
9676eliminated when the @option{-g} option is used.
9677@end defmac
9678
9679@defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
9680A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9681having address @var{x} (an RTL expression).  The nominal offset is
9682@var{offset}.
9683@end defmac
9684
9685@defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
9686A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
9687produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}.  Define
9688this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
9689debugging output.  Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
9690@code{DWARF2_DEBUG}, @code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG},
9691and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
9692
9693When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
9694value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
9695exceptions.  If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
9696value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}.  Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9697defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9698
9699The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9700user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9701@option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9702@end defmac
9703
9704@node DBX Options
9705@subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9706
9707@c prevent bad page break with this line
9708These are specific options for DBX output.
9709
9710@defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9711Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9712in response to the @option{-g} option.
9713@end defmac
9714
9715@defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9716Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9717in response to the @option{-g} option.  This is a variant of DBX format.
9718@end defmac
9719
9720@defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9721Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9722GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9723debugging information is enabled at all).  If you don't define the
9724macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9725if there is any occasion to.
9726@end defmac
9727
9728@defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9729Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9730in the text section.
9731@end defmac
9732
9733@defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9734A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9735use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9736If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used.  This macro
9737applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9738@end defmac
9739
9740@defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9741A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9742use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9743value is the current location.  If you don't define this macro,
9744@code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used.  This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9745information format.
9746@end defmac
9747
9748@defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9749A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9750use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9751name.  If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used.  This
9752macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9753@end defmac
9754
9755@defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9756Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9757@samp{xs@var{tagname}}.  On some systems, this construct is used to
9758describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9759On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9760@end defmac
9761
9762@defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9763A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9764continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9765exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters).  On some
9766operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9767must not be done.  You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9768with the value zero.  You can override the default splitting-length by
9769defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9770@end defmac
9771
9772@defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9773Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9774the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows.  To use
9775a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9776constant for the character you want to use.  Do not define this macro
9777if backslash is correct for your system.
9778@end defmac
9779
9780@defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9781Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9782outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9783variable.
9784@end defmac
9785
9786@defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9787The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9788for a typedef.  The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9789@end defmac
9790
9791@defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9792The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9793for a static variable located in the text section.  DBX format does not
9794provide any ``right'' way to do this.  The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9795@end defmac
9796
9797@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9798The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9799for a parameter passed in registers.  DBX format does not provide any
9800``right'' way to do this.  The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9801@end defmac
9802
9803@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9804The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9805passed in registers.  DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9806do this.  The default is @code{'P'}.
9807@end defmac
9808
9809@defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9810Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9811arguments should precede the assembler code for the function.  Normally,
9812in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9813code.
9814@end defmac
9815
9816@defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9817Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9818the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9819relative to the start of the enclosing function.  Normally, GCC uses
9820an absolute address.
9821@end defmac
9822
9823@defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9824Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9825the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9826start of the enclosing function.  Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
9827@end defmac
9828
9829@defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
9830Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
9831@code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems.  This
9832macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9833number and a type number within the file.  Normally, GCC does not
9834generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9835number for a type number.
9836@end defmac
9837
9838@node DBX Hooks
9839@subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9840
9841@c prevent bad page break with this line
9842These are hooks for DBX format.
9843
9844@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9845A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9846number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9847@var{stream}.  @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
9848invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9849unique labels in the assembly output.
9850
9851This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9852if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9853@end defmac
9854
9855@defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
9856Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
9857@code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
9858On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9859disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9860@end defmac
9861
9862@defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9863Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9864extension construct.  On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9865feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9866@end defmac
9867
9868@node File Names and DBX
9869@subsection File Names in DBX Format
9870
9871@c prevent bad page break with this line
9872This describes file names in DBX format.
9873
9874@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9875A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
9876@var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
9877file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9878This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9879
9880This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9881for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
9882
9883It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9884text section.  You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9885to do so.  If you do this, you must also set the variable
9886@var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
9887@end defmac
9888
9889@defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9890Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9891of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9892the beginning of the file.
9893@end defmac
9894
9895@defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9896Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9897that this object file was compiled by GCC@.  The default is to emit
9898an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9899@samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
9900@end defmac
9901
9902@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9903A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
9904compilation of the main source file @var{name}.  Output should be
9905written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9906
9907If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9908of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
9909@end defmac
9910
9911@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9912Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9913@code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
9914the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
9915whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9916@end defmac
9917
9918@need 2000
9919@node DWARF
9920@subsection Macros for DWARF Output
9921
9922@c prevent bad page break with this line
9923Here are macros for DWARF output.
9924
9925@defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
9926Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
9927debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
9928
9929@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION (const_tree @var{function})
9930Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9931be emitted for each function.  Instead of an integer return the enum
9932value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9933@end deftypefn
9934
9935To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9936define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9937@code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9938prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
9939as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
9940@end defmac
9941
9942@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
9943Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
9944Dwarf 2 frame information.  If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9945(@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9946exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9947how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
9948@end defmac
9949
9950@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO (void)
9951This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9952unwind information to the debugger.  Normally the hook will return
9953@code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9954return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9955
9956A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9957is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9958
9959A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9960This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9961@end deftypefn
9962
9963@defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
9964Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9965line debug info sections.  This will result in much more compact line number
9966tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
9967@end defmac
9968
9969@defmac DWARF2_ASM_VIEW_DEBUG_INFO
9970Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler supports view
9971assignment and verification in @code{.loc}.  If it does not, but the
9972user enables location views, the compiler may have to fallback to
9973internal line number tables.
9974@end defmac
9975
9976@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_RESET_LOCATION_VIEW (rtx_insn *@var{})
9977This hook, if defined, enables -ginternal-reset-location-views, and
9978uses its result to override cases in which the estimated min insn
9979length might be nonzero even when a PC advance (i.e., a view reset)
9980cannot be taken for granted.
9981
9982If the hook is defined, it must return a positive value to indicate
9983the insn definitely advances the PC, and so the view number can be
9984safely assumed to be reset; a negative value to mean the insn
9985definitely does not advance the PC, and os the view number must not
9986be reset; or zero to decide based on the estimated insn length.
9987
9988If insn length is to be regarded as reliable, set the hook to
9989@code{hook_int_rtx_insn_0}.
9990@end deftypefn
9991
9992@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9993True if the @code{.debug_pubtypes} and @code{.debug_pubnames} sections should be emitted.  These sections are not used on most platforms, and in particular GDB does not use them.
9994@end deftypevr
9995
9996@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_SCHED2
9997True if sched2 is not to be run at its normal place.
9998This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
9999@end deftypevr
10000
10001@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_VARTRACK
10002True if vartrack is not to be run at its normal place.
10003This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
10004@end deftypevr
10005
10006@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NO_REGISTER_ALLOCATION
10007True if register allocation and the passes
10008following it should not be run.  Usually true only for virtual assembler
10009targets.
10010@end deftypevr
10011
10012@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
10013A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
10014@var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
10015@end defmac
10016
10017@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
10018A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
10019between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
10020slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
10021@end defmac
10022
10023@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{offset}, @var{section})
10024A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
10025section-relative reference to the given @var{label} plus @var{offset}, using
10026an integer of the given @var{size}.  The label is known to be defined in the
10027given @var{section}.
10028@end defmac
10029
10030@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
10031A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
10032reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
10033@end defmac
10034
10035@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DATAREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
10036A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to the
10037given @var{label} relative to the dbase, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
10038@end defmac
10039
10040@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
10041A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
10042the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section.  This
10043is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
10044is referenced by a function.
10045@end defmac
10046
10047@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{size}, rtx @var{x})
10048If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
10049reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
10050@end deftypefn
10051
10052@need 2000
10053@node VMS Debug
10054@subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
10055
10056@c prevent bad page break with this line
10057Here are macros for VMS debug format.
10058
10059@defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10060Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
10061in response to the @option{-g} option.  The default behavior for VMS
10062is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
10063@option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}.  This
10064behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
10065@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
10066@end defmac
10067
10068@node Floating Point
10069@section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
10070@cindex cross compilation and floating point
10071@cindex floating point and cross compilation
10072
10073While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
10074there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers.  This
10075means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
10076in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
10077doing the compilation.
10078
10079Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
10080range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
10081the target machine's format.  Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
10082safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
10083the target's arithmetic.  To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
10084emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
10085target floating point formats are identical.
10086
10087The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
10088use.  All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
10089floating-point calculations must use these macros.  They may evaluate
10090their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
10091
10092@defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
10093The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
10094machine's format.  Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
10095array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
10096quantity.
10097@end defmac
10098
10099@deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
10100Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
10101@end deftypefn
10102
10103@deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
10104Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero.  If
10105@var{x} is negative, returns zero.
10106@end deftypefn
10107
10108@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, machine_mode @var{mode})
10109Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
10110representation for mode @var{mode}.  This routine can handle both
10111decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
10112defined by the C language for both.
10113@end deftypefn
10114
10115@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
10116Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
10117@end deftypefn
10118
10119@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
10120Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
10121@end deftypefn
10122
10123@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
10124Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
10125@end deftypefn
10126
10127@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
10128Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
10129@end deftypefn
10130
10131@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
10132Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
10133@end deftypefn
10134
10135@node Mode Switching
10136@section Mode Switching Instructions
10137@cindex mode switching
10138The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
10139
10140@defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
10141Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
10142switching in an optimizing compilation.
10143
10144For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
10145floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
10146the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
10147operation, this bit has to be set.  Changing the PR bit requires a general
10148purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
10149be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you cannot put this into instruction emitting
10150or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
10151
10152You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
10153which entities actually need it.  @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
10154return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
10155If you define this macro, you also have to define
10156@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{TARGET_MODE_NEEDED},
10157@code{TARGET_MODE_PRIORITY} and @code{TARGET_MODE_EMIT}.
10158@code{TARGET_MODE_AFTER}, @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT}
10159are optional.
10160@end defmac
10161
10162@defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
10163If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
10164initializer for an array of integers.  Each initializer element
10165N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
10166of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
10167The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
10168zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
10169entity in question.
10170In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
10171represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1.  N is used to specify that no mode
10172switch is needed / supplied.
10173@end defmac
10174
10175@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MODE_EMIT (int @var{entity}, int @var{mode}, int @var{prev_mode}, HARD_REG_SET @var{regs_live})
10176Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}. @var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where the insn(s) are to be inserted. @var{prev_moxde} indicates the mode to switch from. Sets of a lower numbered entity will be emitted before sets of a higher numbered entity to a mode of the same or lower priority.
10177@end deftypefn
10178
10179@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_NEEDED (int @var{entity}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
10180@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity.  If @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
10181@end deftypefn
10182
10183@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_AFTER (int @var{entity}, int @var{mode}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
10184@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity.  If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during mode switching.  It determines the mode that an insn results in (if different from the incoming mode).
10185@end deftypefn
10186
10187@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_ENTRY (int @var{entity})
10188If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs mode switching.  It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry.  If @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY} is defined then @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
10189@end deftypefn
10190
10191@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_EXIT (int @var{entity})
10192If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs mode switching.  It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit.  If @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT} is defined then @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
10193@end deftypefn
10194
10195@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_PRIORITY (int @var{entity}, int @var{n})
10196This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed. 0 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the lowest.  The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode for @var{entity}.  For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority} (@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{} @code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
10197@end deftypefn
10198
10199@node Target Attributes
10200@section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
10201@cindex target attributes
10202@cindex machine attributes
10203@cindex attributes, target-specific
10204
10205Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
10206These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
10207be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
10208
10209@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct attribute_spec *} TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
10210If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
10211attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree-core.h}) specifying the machine
10212specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
10213entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
10214take.
10215@end deftypevr
10216
10217@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P (const_tree @var{name})
10218If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
10219machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
10220given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
10221subjected to name lookup.  If this is not defined, the default is
10222false for all machine-specific attributes.
10223@end deftypefn
10224
10225@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
10226If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
10227@var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
10228and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
10229generated).  If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
10230supposed always to be compatible.
10231@end deftypefn
10232
10233@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type})
10234If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
10235the newly defined @var{type}.
10236@end deftypefn
10237
10238@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
10239Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
10240handling.  If defined, the result is a list of the combined
10241@code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}.  It is assumed
10242that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1.  This
10243function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
10244merging.
10245@end deftypefn
10246
10247@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{olddecl}, tree @var{newdecl})
10248Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
10249handling.  If defined, the result is a list of the combined
10250@code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
10251@var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}.  Examples of
10252when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
10253attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition.  This function may
10254call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
10255
10256@findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
10257If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
10258for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
10259@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}.  The compiler
10260will then define a function called
10261@code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
10262the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.  You can also
10263add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
10264to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
10265@samp{dllexport} attributes.  This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
10266@file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
10267@end deftypefn
10268
10269@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P (const_tree @var{decl})
10270@var{decl} is a variable or function with @code{__attribute__((dllimport))} specified.  Use this hook if the target needs to add extra validation checks to @code{handle_dll_attribute}.
10271@end deftypefn
10272
10273@defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
10274Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
10275@code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}.  By
10276default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
10277@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.  The current implementation
10278of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
10279on this implementation detail.
10280@end defmac
10281
10282@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{node}, tree *@var{attr_ptr})
10283Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
10284when it is being created.  This is normally useful for back ends which
10285wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
10286the pragma's effect.  The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
10287created.  The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
10288for this decl.  The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
10289shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
10290the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
10291attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
10292needed.
10293@end deftypefn
10294
10295@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P (const_tree @var{fndecl})
10296@cindex inlining
10297This target hook returns @code{true} if it is OK to inline @var{fndecl}
10298into the current function, despite its having target-specific
10299attributes, @code{false} otherwise.  By default, if a function has a
10300target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
10301@end deftypefn
10302
10303@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{name}, tree @var{args}, int @var{flags})
10304This hook is called to parse @code{attribute(target("..."))}, which
10305allows setting target-specific options on individual functions.
10306These function-specific options may differ
10307from the options specified on the command line.  The hook should return
10308@code{true} if the options are valid.
10309
10310The hook should set the @code{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
10311the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target-specific
10312@code{struct cl_target_option} structure.
10313@end deftypefn
10314
10315@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_SAVE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
10316This hook is called to save any additional target-specific information
10317in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for function-specific
10318options from the @code{struct gcc_options} structure.
10319@xref{Option file format}.
10320@end deftypefn
10321
10322@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
10323This hook is called to restore any additional target-specific
10324information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for
10325function-specific options to the @code{struct gcc_options} structure.
10326@end deftypefn
10327
10328@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_POST_STREAM_IN (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
10329This hook is called to update target-specific information in the
10330@code{struct cl_target_option} structure after it is streamed in from
10331LTO bytecode.
10332@end deftypefn
10333
10334@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_PRINT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{indent}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
10335This hook is called to print any additional target-specific
10336information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for
10337function-specific options.
10338@end deftypefn
10339
10340@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE (tree @var{args}, tree @var{pop_target})
10341This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC target}, which
10342sets the target-specific options for functions that occur later in the
10343input stream.  The options accepted should be the same as those handled by the
10344@code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
10345@end deftypefn
10346
10347@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE (void)
10348Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
10349a particular target machine.  You can override the hook
10350@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this.  This hooks is called
10351once just after all the command options have been parsed.
10352
10353Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
10354@option{-O}.  That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
10355
10356If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
10357changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
10358@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
10359@end deftypefn
10360
10361@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_FUNCTION_VERSIONS (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
10362This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are
10363versions of the same function.  @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are function
10364versions if and only if they have the same function signature and
10365different target specific attributes, that is, they are compiled for
10366different target machines.
10367@end deftypefn
10368
10369@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P (tree @var{caller}, tree @var{callee})
10370This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
10371cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information.  By
10372default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
10373specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
10374@end deftypefn
10375
10376@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_RELAYOUT_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl})
10377This target hook fixes function @var{fndecl} after attributes are processed. Default does nothing. On ARM, the default function's alignment is updated with the attribute target.
10378@end deftypefn
10379
10380@node Emulated TLS
10381@section Emulating TLS
10382@cindex Emulated TLS
10383
10384For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
10385specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
10386used.  A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
10387configured for the requirements of a particular target.  For instance
10388the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
10389layer.
10390
10391The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
10392object.  To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
10393which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
10394address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
10395
10396@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
10397Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
10398object to locate a TLS instance.  The default causes libgcc's
10399emulated TLS helper function to be used.
10400@end deftypevr
10401
10402@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
10403Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
10404program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
10405initialized to zero.  If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
10406have explicit initializers.  The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
10407registration function to be used.
10408@end deftypevr
10409
10410@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
10411Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
10412be placed.  The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
10413any section.
10414@end deftypevr
10415
10416@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
10417Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
10418placed.  The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
10419section.
10420@end deftypevr
10421
10422@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
10423Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
10424The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
10425@end deftypevr
10426
10427@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
10428Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects.  The
10429default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
10430@end deftypevr
10431
10432@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS (tree @var{type}, tree *@var{name})
10433Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
10434object type.  @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
10435@var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
10436@code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable.  The default creates a type suitable
10437for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
10438@end deftypefn
10439
10440@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT (tree @var{var}, tree @var{decl}, tree @var{tmpl_addr})
10441Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
10442TLS control object.  @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
10443is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
10444initializer.  The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
10445@end deftypefn
10446
10447@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
10448Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
10449fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
10450single objects.  The default is false.
10451@end deftypevr
10452
10453@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
10454Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
10455may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
10456@end deftypevr
10457
10458@node MIPS Coprocessors
10459@section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
10460@cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
10461
10462The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
10463coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers.  GCC supports
10464accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
10465and memory using asm-ized variables.  For example:
10466
10467@smallexample
10468  register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
10469  unsigned int d;
10470
10471  d = cp0count + 3;
10472@end smallexample
10473
10474(``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
10475names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
10476overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
10477
10478Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
10479be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
10480later in the function.
10481
10482Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
10483the FPU@.  One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
10484floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
10485
10486@node PCH Target
10487@section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
10488@cindex parameters, precompiled headers
10489
10490@deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY (size_t *@var{sz})
10491This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
10492@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
10493@samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
10494@end deftypefn
10495
10496@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_PCH_VALID_P (const void *@var{data}, size_t @var{sz})
10497This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
10498compatible with the current settings.  It returns @code{NULL}
10499if so and a suitable error message if not.  Error messages will
10500be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
10501
10502@var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
10503when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
10504It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
10505compiler, so no format checking is needed.
10506
10507The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
10508suitable for most targets.
10509@end deftypefn
10510
10511@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS (int @var{pch_flags})
10512If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
10513@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
10514of @code{target_flags}.  @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
10515@code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created.  The return
10516value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
10517@end deftypefn
10518
10519@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_PREPARE_PCH_SAVE (void)
10520Called before writing out a PCH file.  If the target has some
10521garbage-collected data that needs to be in a particular state on PCH loads,
10522it can use this hook to enforce that state.  Very few targets need
10523to do anything here.
10524@end deftypefn
10525
10526@node C++ ABI
10527@section C++ ABI parameters
10528@cindex parameters, c++ abi
10529
10530@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE (void)
10531Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
10532These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects.  The
10533default is long_long_integer_type_node.
10534@end deftypefn
10535
10536@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT (void)
10537This hook determines how guard variables are used.  It should return
10538@code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used.  A return value of
10539@code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
10540@end deftypefn
10541
10542@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE (tree @var{type})
10543This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
10544whose elements have the indicated @var{type}.  Assumes that it is already
10545known that a cookie is needed.  The default is
10546@code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
10547IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
10548@end deftypefn
10549
10550@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE (void)
10551This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
10552array cookies.  The default is to return @code{false}.
10553@end deftypefn
10554
10555@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS (tree @var{type}, int @var{import_export})
10556If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
10557class @var{type} to be overruled.  Upon entry @var{import_export}
10558will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
10559to be imported and 0 otherwise.  This function should return the
10560modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
10561backend's targeted operating system.
10562@end deftypefn
10563
10564@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS (void)
10565This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
10566the address of the object created/destroyed.  The default is to return
10567@code{false}.
10568@end deftypefn
10569
10570@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE (void)
10571This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
10572which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
10573table to be emitted) may be an inline function.  Under the standard
10574Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
10575the function is not declared inline in the class definition.  Under
10576some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
10577method.  The default is to return @code{true}.
10578@end deftypefn
10579
10580@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl})
10581@var{decl} is a virtual table, virtual table table, typeinfo object, or other similar implicit class data object that will be emitted with external linkage in this translation unit.  No ELF visibility has been explicitly specified.  If the target needs to specify a visibility other than that of the containing class, use this hook to set @code{DECL_VISIBILITY} and @code{DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED}.
10582@end deftypefn
10583
10584@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT (void)
10585This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10586similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10587external linkage.  If this hook returns false, then class data for
10588classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10589unit will not be COMDAT.
10590@end deftypefn
10591
10592@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT (void)
10593This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10594the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10595be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10596@end deftypefn
10597
10598@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT (void)
10599This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10600should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10601is in effect.  The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10602@end deftypefn
10603
10604@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT (void)
10605This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10606in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10607destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10608shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10609unloaded. The default is to return false.
10610@end deftypefn
10611
10612@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION (tree @var{type})
10613@var{type} is a C++ class (i.e., RECORD_TYPE or UNION_TYPE) that has just been defined.  Use this hook to make adjustments to the class (eg, tweak visibility or perform any other required target modifications).
10614@end deftypefn
10615
10616@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_DECL_MANGLING_CONTEXT (const_tree @var{decl})
10617Return target-specific mangling context of @var{decl} or @code{NULL_TREE}.
10618@end deftypefn
10619
10620@node Named Address Spaces
10621@section Adding support for named address spaces
10622@cindex named address spaces
10623
10624The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10625standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10626support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10627processors to specify alternate address spaces.  You can configure a
10628GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10629address spaces other than the default address space.  These address
10630spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10631@code{const} type attributes.
10632
10633Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
10634pointers to the generic address space.
10635
10636For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10637to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10638processor.  Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10639issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10640local processor memory address space.  Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10641address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10642@option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10643always 32 bits).
10644
10645Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10646range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10647address space.
10648
10649To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10650the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine.  For example,
10651the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10652named address space #1:
10653@smallexample
10654#define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
10655c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
10656@end smallexample
10657
10658@deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10659Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10660@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10661The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode}.
10662@end deftypefn
10663
10664@deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10665Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10666@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10667The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode}.
10668@end deftypefn
10669
10670@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE (scalar_int_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10671Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10672with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}.  This target
10673hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10674except that it includes explicit named address space support.  The default
10675version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10676@code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10677target hooks for the given address space.
10678@end deftypefn
10679
10680@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{exp}, bool @var{strict}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10681Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10682@var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}.  The @var{strict}
10683parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10684finished.  This target hook is the same as the
10685@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10686explicit named address space support.
10687@end deftypefn
10688
10689@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10690Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10691with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}.  This target
10692hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10693except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10694@end deftypefn
10695
10696@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P (addr_space_t @var{subset}, addr_space_t @var{superset})
10697Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10698contained within the @var{superset} named address space.  Pointers to
10699a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10700will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10701arithmetic operations.  Pointers to a superset address space can be
10702converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10703@end deftypefn
10704
10705@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ZERO_ADDRESS_VALID (addr_space_t @var{as})
10706Define this to modify the default handling of address 0 for the
10707address space.  Return true if 0 should be considered a valid address.
10708@end deftypefn
10709
10710@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT (rtx @var{op}, tree @var{from_type}, tree @var{to_type})
10711Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10712@var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10713space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10714to a different named address space.  When this hook it called, it is
10715guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10716as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10717@end deftypefn
10718
10719@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_DEBUG (addr_space_t @var{as})
10720Define this to define how the address space is encoded in dwarf.
10721The result is the value to be used with @code{DW_AT_address_class}.
10722@end deftypefn
10723
10724@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_DIAGNOSE_USAGE (addr_space_t @var{as}, location_t @var{loc})
10725Define this hook if the availability of an address space depends on
10726command line options and some diagnostics should be printed when the
10727address space is used.  This hook is called during parsing and allows
10728to emit a better diagnostic compared to the case where the address space
10729was not registered with @code{c_register_addr_space}.  @var{as} is
10730the address space as registered with @code{c_register_addr_space}.
10731@var{loc} is the location of the address space qualifier token.
10732The default implementation does nothing.
10733@end deftypefn
10734
10735@node Misc
10736@section Miscellaneous Parameters
10737@cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10738
10739@c prevent bad page break with this line
10740Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10741
10742@defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10743Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10744has conditional branches that can span all of memory.  It is used in
10745conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10746blocks into separate sections of the executable.  If this macro is
10747set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10748to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10749@end defmac
10750
10751@defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10752Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10753has unconditional branches that can span all of memory.  It is used in
10754conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10755blocks into separate sections of the executable.  If this macro is
10756set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10757to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10758@end defmac
10759
10760@defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10761An alias for a machine mode name.  This is the machine mode that
10762elements of a jump-table should have.
10763@end defmac
10764
10765@defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10766Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10767when the minimum and maximum offset are known.  If you define this,
10768it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10769To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10770make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10771The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10772flags can be updated.
10773@end defmac
10774
10775@defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10776Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10777should contain relative addresses.  You need not define this macro if
10778jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10779contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10780is in effect.
10781@end defmac
10782
10783@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD (void)
10784This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10785is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10786The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10787five otherwise.  This is best for most machines.
10788@end deftypefn
10789
10790@defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10791Define this macro to 1 if operations between registers with integral mode
10792smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.  To be
10793more explicit, if you start with a pair of @code{word_mode} registers with
10794known values and you do a subword, for example @code{QImode}, addition on
10795the low part of the registers, then the compiler may consider that the
10796result has a known value in @code{word_mode} too if the macro is defined
10797to 1.  Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10798@end defmac
10799
10800@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MIN_ARITHMETIC_PRECISION (void)
10801On some RISC architectures with 64-bit registers, the processor also
10802maintains 32-bit condition codes that make it possible to do real 32-bit
10803arithmetic, although the operations are performed on the full registers.
10804
10805On such architectures, defining this hook to 32 tells the compiler to try
10806using 32-bit arithmetical operations setting the condition codes instead
10807of doing full 64-bit arithmetic.
10808
10809More generally, define this hook on RISC architectures if you want the
10810compiler to try using arithmetical operations setting the condition codes
10811with a precision lower than the word precision.
10812
10813You need not define this hook if @code{WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS} is not
10814defined to 1.
10815@end deftypefn
10816
10817@defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
10818Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
10819memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10820bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
10821zero-extension of the data read.  Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
10822of @var{mem_mode} for which the
10823insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
10824@code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
10825
10826This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
10827greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10828value in this case.  Do not define this macro if it would always return
10829@code{UNKNOWN}.  On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
10830define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
10831
10832You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
10833the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10834of these hard registers @code{TARGET_CAN_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns false
10835when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10836integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10837
10838You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
10839mode, @code{TARGET_CAN_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10840@code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10841is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
10842@end defmac
10843
10844@defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
10845Define this macro to 1 if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10846extends.
10847@end defmac
10848
10849@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL (machine_mode @var{mode})
10850When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10851divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10852the reciprocal.  This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10853that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10854of mode @var{mode}.  The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10855has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10856@end deftypefn
10857
10858@defmac MOVE_MAX
10859The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10860between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
10861@end defmac
10862
10863@defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
10864The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10865between memory and registers or between two memory locations.  If this
10866is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}.  Otherwise, it is the
10867constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10868at run-time.
10869@end defmac
10870
10871@defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
10872A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10873actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10874of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted.  When
10875this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
10876a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10877truncates the count of a shift operation.  On machines that have
10878instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
10879include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10880also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
10881arguments to bit-field instructions.
10882
10883If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
10884position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
10885instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10886
10887However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10888only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
10889bit-field operations.  Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
10890such machines.  Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10891the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10892
10893You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
10894@end defmac
10895
10896@anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
10897@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK (machine_mode @var{mode})
10898This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10899deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10900@xref{shift patterns}.
10901
10902On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10903shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10904equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}.  If
10905this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10906otherwise it should return 0.  A return value of 0 indicates that no
10907particular behavior is guaranteed.
10908
10909Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10910@emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10911that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10912
10913The default implementation of this function returns
10914@code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10915and 0 otherwise.  This definition is always safe, but if
10916@code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10917nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10918by overriding it.
10919@end deftypefn
10920
10921@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (poly_uint64 @var{outprec}, poly_uint64 @var{inprec})
10922This hook returns true if it is safe to ``convert'' a value of
10923@var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec} bits (where @var{outprec} is
10924smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely operating on it as if it had only
10925@var{outprec} bits.  The default returns true unconditionally, which
10926is correct for most machines.
10927
10928If @code{TARGET_MODES_TIEABLE_P} returns false for a pair of modes,
10929suboptimal code can result if this hook returns true for the corresponding
10930mode sizes.  Making this hook return false in such cases may improve things.
10931@end deftypefn
10932
10933@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (scalar_int_mode @var{mode}, scalar_int_mode @var{rep_mode})
10934The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
10935are always extended to a wider integral mode.  Return
10936@code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10937sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}.  Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10938otherwise.  (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10939representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10940@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10941@code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}.  Also no target extends
10942@var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
10943widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10944
10945Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10946value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10947as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10948@code{TARGET_CAN_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns false.
10949
10950Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10951describe two related properties.  If you define
10952@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10953to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10954extension.
10955
10956In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10957@code{TARGET_TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10958@code{mode}.
10959@end deftypefn
10960
10961@defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
10962A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10963with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
10964(@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true.  This description must
10965apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
10966comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10967
10968A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10969comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
10970and 0 when the comparison is false.  Otherwise, the value indicates
10971which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10972true.  This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10973operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
10974@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern.  Either the low bit or the sign bit of
10975@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on.  Presently, only those bits are used by
10976the compiler.
10977
10978If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
10979generate code that depends only on the specified bits.  It can also
10980replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10981the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10982For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10983@code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10984@samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10985expression
10986
10987@smallexample
10988(ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10989@end smallexample
10990
10991@noindent
10992can be converted to
10993
10994@smallexample
10995(ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10996@end smallexample
10997
10998@noindent
10999where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
11000tested into the sign bit.
11001
11002There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
11003for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
11004but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction.  If you
11005are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
11006perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
11007comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
11008
11009Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
11010from a comparison (or the condition codes).  Here are rules to guide the
11011choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
11012to be used:
11013
11014@itemize @bullet
11015@item
11016Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
11017@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}.  It is more efficient for the compiler to
11018``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
11019comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
11020combine the normalization with other operations.
11021
11022@item
11023For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
11024slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
11025other machines.
11026
11027@item
11028As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
11029exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
11030others.
11031
11032@item
11033Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
11034@end itemize
11035
11036Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
11037@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
11038instructions.  On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
11039those cases, e.g., one matching
11040
11041@smallexample
11042(set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
11043@end smallexample
11044
11045Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
11046condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
11047@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}.  On those
11048machines, define the appropriate patterns.  Use the names @code{incscc}
11049and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
11050@code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values.  See
11051@file{rs6000.md} for some examples.  The GNU Superoptimizer can be used to
11052find such instruction sequences on other machines.
11053
11054If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used.  You need
11055not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
11056instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
11057@end defmac
11058
11059@defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
11060A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
11061returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
11062Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
11063floating-point values.  If there are no such operations, do not define
11064this macro.
11065@end defmac
11066
11067@defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
11068A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
11069for vector comparisons.  The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
11070mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode.  Define
11071this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
11072return a vector result.  If there are no such operations, do not define
11073this macro.  Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
11074@code{constm1_rtx}.  This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
11075the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
11076given mode.
11077@end defmac
11078
11079@defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
11080@defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
11081A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
11082for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
11083A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
11084If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
11085evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
11086entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
11087the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
11088In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
11089this value.
11090
11091If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
11092@code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
11093
11094This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
11095relies on a particular value to get correct results.  Otherwise it
11096is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
11097to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
11098
11099Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
11100and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
11101visible to the user.  Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
11102to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
11103breaking the API@.
11104@end defmac
11105
11106@defmac Pmode
11107An alias for the machine mode for pointers.  On most machines, define
11108this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
11109pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
11110On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
11111modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
11112
11113The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
11114@code{POINTER_SIZE}.  If it is not equal, you must define the macro
11115@code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
11116to @code{Pmode}.
11117@end defmac
11118
11119@defmac FUNCTION_MODE
11120An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
11121being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions.  On most CISC machines,
11122where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
11123@code{QImode}.  On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
11124size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
11125as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
11126@end defmac
11127
11128@defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
11129In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
11130constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@.  On some
11131hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
11132where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
11133strict conformance to the C Standard.
11134
11135Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
11136convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
11137files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
11138@end defmac
11139
11140@deftypefn {C Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_C_PREINCLUDE (void)
11141Define this hook to return the name of a header file to be included at the start of all compilations, as if it had been included with @code{#include <@var{file}>}.  If this hook returns @code{NULL}, or is not defined, or the header is not found, or if the user specifies @option{-ffreestanding} or @option{-nostdinc}, no header is included.
11142
11143 This hook can be used together with a header provided by the system C library to implement ISO C requirements for certain macros to be predefined that describe properties of the whole implementation rather than just the compiler.
11144@end deftypefn
11145
11146@deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C (const char*@var{})
11147Define this hook to add target-specific C++ implicit extern C functions. If this function returns true for the name of a file-scope function, that function implicitly gets extern "C" linkage rather than whatever language linkage the declaration would normally have.  An example of such function is WinMain on Win32 targets.
11148@end deftypefn
11149
11150@defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
11151Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
11152This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
11153C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
11154@samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
11155@end defmac
11156
11157@findex #pragma
11158@findex pragma
11159@defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
11160Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
11161If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
11162@code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
11163for each pragma.  The macro may also do any
11164setup required for the pragmas.
11165
11166The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
11167other compilers for the same target.  In general, we discourage
11168definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
11169
11170If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
11171defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
11172
11173Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded.  All
11174@samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
11175silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
11176@end defmac
11177
11178@deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
11179@deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
11180
11181Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
11182@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma.  The
11183@var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
11184pragma of the form
11185
11186@smallexample
11187#pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
11188@end smallexample
11189
11190@var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
11191@code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace.  The callback
11192routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
11193on to cpplib's functions if necessary.  You can lex tokens after the
11194@var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}.  Tokens that are not read by the
11195callback will be silently ignored.  The end of the line is indicated by
11196a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}.  Macro expansion occurs on the
11197arguments of pragmas registered with
11198@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
11199pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
11200
11201Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
11202compilers.  It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
11203other language compilers for that matter.  Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
11204to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
11205building the C and C++ compilers.  This can be done by defining the
11206variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
11207target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file.  These variables should name
11208the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
11209code that uses @code{pragma_lex}.  Note it will also be necessary to add a
11210rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
11211how to build this object file.
11212@end deftypefun
11213
11214@defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
11215Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
11216arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
11217@end defmac
11218
11219@defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
11220If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
11221the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
11222This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
11223@samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
11224@end defmac
11225
11226@defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
11227Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
11228identifier names for the C family of languages.  0 means @samp{$} is
11229not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed.  1 is the default;
11230there is no need to define this macro in that case.
11231@end defmac
11232
11233@defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
11234Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
11235delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
11236even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
11237@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
11238every @code{call_insn} has this behavior.  On machines where some @code{insn}
11239or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
11240you should define this macro.
11241
11242You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
11243@end defmac
11244
11245@defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
11246Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
11247delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
11248even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
11249@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}.  On machines where
11250some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
11251are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
11252define this macro.  Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
11253instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
11254slot of @var{insn}.
11255
11256You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
11257@end defmac
11258
11259@defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
11260Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
11261global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
11262symbols in another translation unit without user intervention.  For
11263instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
11264from shared libraries (DLLs).
11265
11266You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
11267@end defmac
11268
11269@deftypefn {Target Hook} {rtx_insn *} TARGET_MD_ASM_ADJUST (vec<rtx>& @var{outputs}, vec<rtx>& @var{inputs}, vec<const char *>& @var{constraints}, vec<rtx>& @var{clobbers}, HARD_REG_SET& @var{clobbered_regs})
11270This target hook may add @dfn{clobbers} to @var{clobbers} and
11271@var{clobbered_regs} for any hard regs the port wishes to automatically
11272clobber for an asm.  The @var{outputs} and @var{inputs} may be inspected
11273to avoid clobbering a register that is already used by the asm.
11274
11275It may modify the @var{outputs}, @var{inputs}, and @var{constraints}
11276as necessary for other pre-processing.  In this case the return value is
11277a sequence of insns to emit after the asm.
11278@end deftypefn
11279
11280@defmac MATH_LIBRARY
11281Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
11282in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
11283@samp{""} if the target does not have a
11284separate math library.
11285
11286You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
11287@end defmac
11288
11289@defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
11290Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
11291specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
11292
11293You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
11294is wrong.
11295@end defmac
11296
11297@defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
11298Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
11299functions, access, mkdir and  file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
11300Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
11301to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
11302if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
11303for cross-profiling.
11304@end defmac
11305
11306@defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
11307
11308A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
11309conditional execution instructions instead of a branch.  A value of
11310@code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
113111 if it does use cc0.
11312@end defmac
11313
11314@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
11315Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
11316conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
11317@var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
11318contains information about the currently processed blocks.  @var{true_expr}
11319and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
11320then-block and the else-block, respectively.  Set either @var{true_expr} or
11321@var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
11322@end defmac
11323
11324@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
11325Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
11326if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
11327@var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
11328being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
11329@end defmac
11330
11331@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
11332A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
11333be converted to conditional execution format.  @var{ce_info} points to
11334a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
11335about the currently processed blocks.
11336@end defmac
11337
11338@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
11339A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
11340converting code to conditional execution.  The involved basic blocks
11341can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
11342to by @var{ce_info}.
11343@end defmac
11344
11345@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
11346A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
11347converting code to conditional execution.  The involved basic blocks
11348can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
11349to by @var{ce_info}.
11350@end defmac
11351
11352@defmac IFCVT_MACHDEP_INIT (@var{ce_info})
11353A C expression to initialize any machine specific data for if-conversion
11354of the if-block in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
11355to by @var{ce_info}.
11356@end defmac
11357
11358@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG (void)
11359If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
11360instruction stream.  The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
11361just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
11362
11363The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target.  Some use
11364it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
11365laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
11366Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
11367
11368You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do.  The default
11369definition is null.
11370@end deftypefn
11371
11372@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS (void)
11373Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
11374that need to be defined.  It should be a function that performs the
11375necessary setup.
11376
11377Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
11378instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
11379they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
11380instructions or prefetch instructions).
11381
11382To create a built-in function, call the function
11383@code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
11384which is defined by the language front end.  You can use any type nodes set
11385up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes};
11386only language front ends that use those two functions will call
11387@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
11388@end deftypefn
11389
11390@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL (unsigned @var{code}, bool @var{initialize_p})
11391Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
11392that need to be defined.  It should be a function that returns the
11393builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
11394If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
11395if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
11396If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
11397@code{error_mark_node}.
11398@end deftypefn
11399
11400@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN (tree @var{exp}, rtx @var{target}, rtx @var{subtarget}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{ignore})
11401
11402Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
11403@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.  @var{exp} is the expression for the
11404function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
11405convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
11406@var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
11407@var{exp}'s operands.  @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
11408ignored.  This function should return the result of the call to the
11409built-in function.
11410@end deftypefn
11411
11412@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_CHKP_FUNCTION (unsigned @var{fcode})
11413This hook allows target to redefine built-in functions used by
11414Pointer Bounds Checker for code instrumentation.  Hook should return
11415fndecl of function implementing generic builtin whose code is
11416passed in @var{fcode}.  Currently following built-in functions are
11417obtained using this hook:
11418@deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_bndmk (const void *@var{lb}, size_t @var{size})
11419Function code - BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDMK.  This built-in function is used
11420by Pointer Bounds Checker to create bound values.  @var{lb} holds low
11421bound of the resulting bounds.  @var{size} holds size of created bounds.
11422@end deftypefn
11423
11424@deftypefn {Built-in Function} void __chkp_bndstx (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b}, const void **@var{loc})
11425Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDSTX}.  This built-in function is used
11426by Pointer Bounds Checker to store bounds @var{b} for pointer @var{ptr}
11427when @var{ptr} is stored by address @var{loc}.
11428@end deftypefn
11429
11430@deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_bndldx (const void **@var{loc}, const void *@var{ptr})
11431Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDLDX}.  This built-in function is used
11432by Pointer Bounds Checker to get bounds of pointer @var{ptr} loaded by
11433address @var{loc}.
11434@end deftypefn
11435
11436@deftypefn {Built-in Function} void __chkp_bndcl (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b})
11437Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDCL}.  This built-in function is used
11438by Pointer Bounds Checker to perform check for pointer @var{ptr} against
11439lower bound of bounds @var{b}.
11440@end deftypefn
11441
11442@deftypefn {Built-in Function} void __chkp_bndcu (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b})
11443Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDCU}.  This built-in function is used
11444by Pointer Bounds Checker to perform check for pointer @var{ptr} against
11445upper bound of bounds @var{b}.
11446@end deftypefn
11447
11448@deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_bndret (void *@var{ptr})
11449Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDRET}.  This built-in function is used
11450by Pointer Bounds Checker to obtain bounds returned by a call statement.
11451@var{ptr} passed to built-in is @code{SSA_NAME} returned by the call.
11452@end deftypefn
11453
11454@deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_intersect (__bounds_type @var{b1}, __bounds_type @var{b2})
11455Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_INTERSECT}.  This built-in function
11456returns intersection of bounds @var{b1} and @var{b2}.
11457@end deftypefn
11458
11459@deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_narrow (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b}, size_t @var{s})
11460Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_NARROW}.  This built-in function
11461returns intersection of bounds @var{b} and
11462[@var{ptr}, @var{ptr} + @var{s} - @code{1}].
11463@end deftypefn
11464
11465@deftypefn {Built-in Function} size_t __chkp_sizeof (const void *@var{ptr})
11466Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_SIZEOF}.  This built-in function
11467returns size of object referenced by @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} is always
11468@code{ADDR_EXPR} of @code{VAR_DECL}.  This built-in is used by
11469Pointer Bounds Checker when bounds of object cannot be computed statically
11470(e.g. object has incomplete type).
11471@end deftypefn
11472
11473@deftypefn {Built-in Function} const void *__chkp_extract_lower (__bounds_type @var{b})
11474Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_EXTRACT_LOWER}.  This built-in function
11475returns lower bound of bounds @var{b}.
11476@end deftypefn
11477
11478@deftypefn {Built-in Function} const void *__chkp_extract_upper (__bounds_type @var{b})
11479Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_EXTRACT_UPPER}.  This built-in function
11480returns upper bound of bounds @var{b}.
11481@end deftypefn
11482@end deftypefn
11483@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CHKP_BOUND_TYPE (void)
11484Return type to be used for bounds
11485@end deftypefn
11486@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_CHKP_BOUND_MODE (void)
11487Return mode to be used for bounds.
11488@end deftypefn
11489@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CHKP_MAKE_BOUNDS_CONSTANT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{lb}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{ub})
11490Return constant used to statically initialize constant bounds
11491with specified lower bound @var{lb} and upper bounds @var{ub}.
11492@end deftypefn
11493@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CHKP_INITIALIZE_BOUNDS (tree @var{var}, tree @var{lb}, tree @var{ub}, tree *@var{stmts})
11494Generate a list of statements @var{stmts} to initialize pointer
11495bounds variable @var{var} with bounds @var{lb} and @var{ub}.  Return
11496the number of generated statements.
11497@end deftypefn
11498
11499@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN (unsigned int @var{loc}, tree @var{fndecl}, void *@var{arglist})
11500Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
11501was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.  This is done
11502@emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
11503implement a crude form of function overloading.  @var{fndecl} is the
11504declaration of the built-in function.  @var{arglist} is the list of
11505arguments passed to the built-in function.  The result is a
11506complete expression that implements the operation, usually
11507another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
11508@var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
11509@end deftypefn
11510
11511@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{n_args}, tree *@var{argp}, bool @var{ignore})
11512Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
11513@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.  @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
11514built-in function.  @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
11515the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
11516The result is another tree, valid for both GIMPLE and GENERIC,
11517containing a simplified expression for the call's result.  If
11518@var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
11519@end deftypefn
11520
11521@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GIMPLE_FOLD_BUILTIN (gimple_stmt_iterator *@var{gsi})
11522Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up
11523by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.  @var{gsi} points to the gimple
11524statement holding the function call.  Returns true if any change
11525was made to the GIMPLE stream.
11526@end deftypefn
11527
11528@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPARE_VERSION_PRIORITY (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
11529This hook is used to compare the target attributes in two functions to
11530determine which function's features get higher priority.  This is used
11531during function multi-versioning to figure out the order in which two
11532versions must be dispatched.  A function version with a higher priority
11533is checked for dispatching earlier.  @var{decl1} and @var{decl2} are
11534 the two function decls that will be compared.
11535@end deftypefn
11536
11537@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GET_FUNCTION_VERSIONS_DISPATCHER (void *@var{decl})
11538This hook is used to get the dispatcher function for a set of function
11539versions.  The dispatcher function is called to invoke the right function
11540version at run-time. @var{decl} is one version from a set of semantically
11541identical versions.
11542@end deftypefn
11543
11544@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GENERATE_VERSION_DISPATCHER_BODY (void *@var{arg})
11545This hook is used to generate the dispatcher logic to invoke the right
11546function version at run-time for a given set of function versions.
11547@var{arg} points to the callgraph node of the dispatcher function whose
11548body must be generated.
11549@end deftypefn
11550
11551@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_USE_DOLOOP_P (const widest_int @var{&iterations}, const widest_int @var{&iterations_max}, unsigned int @var{loop_depth}, bool @var{entered_at_top})
11552Return true if it is possible to use low-overhead loops (@code{doloop_end}
11553and @code{doloop_begin}) for a particular loop.  @var{iterations} gives the
11554exact number of iterations, or 0 if not known.  @var{iterations_max} gives
11555the maximum number of iterations, or 0 if not known.  @var{loop_depth} is
11556the nesting depth of the loop, with 1 for innermost loops, 2 for loops that
11557contain innermost loops, and so on.  @var{entered_at_top} is true if the
11558loop is only entered from the top.
11559
11560This hook is only used if @code{doloop_end} is available.  The default
11561implementation returns true.  You can use @code{can_use_doloop_if_innermost}
11562if the loop must be the innermost, and if there are no other restrictions.
11563@end deftypefn
11564
11565@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP (const rtx_insn *@var{insn})
11566
11567Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
11568low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
11569could not be applied.
11570
11571Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
11572instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
11573the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
11574By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
11575loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
11576@end deftypefn
11577
11578@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_COMBINED_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn})
11579Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return @code{false} if the instruction is not appropriate as a combination of two or more instructions.  The default is to accept all instructions.
11580@end deftypefn
11581
11582@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_FOLLOW_JUMP (const rtx_insn *@var{follower}, const rtx_insn *@var{followee})
11583FOLLOWER and FOLLOWEE are JUMP_INSN instructions;  return true if FOLLOWER may be modified to follow FOLLOWEE;  false, if it can't.  For example, on some targets, certain kinds of branches can't be made to  follow through a hot/cold partitioning.
11584@end deftypefn
11585
11586@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P (const_rtx @var{x}, int @var{outer_code})
11587This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
11588Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
11589PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@.  @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
11590of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
11591@end deftypefn
11592
11593@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE (rtx @var{hard_reg})
11594
11595When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
11596register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
11597to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
11598it has been saved into can be used.  @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
11599is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
11600that had its initial value copied by using
11601@code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
11602Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
11603to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
11604the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
11605@code{MEM}.
11606If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
11607it might decide to use another register anyways.
11608You may use @code{current_function_is_leaf} or
11609@code{REG_N_SETS} in the hook to determine if the hard
11610register in question will not be clobbered.
11611The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
11612allocation.
11613@end deftypefn
11614
11615@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P (const_rtx @var{x}, unsigned @var{flags})
11616This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
11617@code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap.  Targets can use
11618this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
11619@code{unspec_volatile} operations.  You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
11620to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
11621passed along.
11622@end deftypefn
11623
11624@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION (tree @var{decl})
11625The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
11626context (@code{cfun}).  You can define this function if
11627the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
11628per-function basis.  For example, it may be used to implement function
11629attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
11630The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
11631and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
11632and is returning to processing at the top level.
11633The default hook function does nothing.
11634
11635GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
11636some parts of the back end.  The hook function is not invoked in this
11637situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
11638or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
11639@code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
11640outside of any function scope.
11641@end deftypefn
11642
11643@defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
11644Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
11645files on your target machine.  If you do not define this macro, GCC will
11646use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
11647@end defmac
11648
11649@defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
11650Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
11651automatically added to executable files on your target machine.  If you
11652do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
11653executable files.
11654@end defmac
11655
11656@defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
11657If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
11658specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
11659Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
11660object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
11661lists.
11662@end defmac
11663
11664@defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
11665Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
11666method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
11667must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
11668For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
11669the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
11670defined as this expression:
11671
11672@smallexample
11673build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
11674                              build_tree_list
11675                              (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
11676                               NULL))
11677@end smallexample
11678@end defmac
11679
11680@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P (void)
11681This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
11682instructions could be created.  On machines that require a register for
11683every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
11684reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
11685
11686@smallexample
11687static bool
11688cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
11689@{
11690  return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
11691@}
11692@end smallexample
11693@end deftypefn
11694
11695@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS (void)
11696This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
11697optimizations should be applied.  All registers in this class should be
11698usable interchangeably.  After reload, registers in this class will be
11699re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
11700to inter-block scheduling.
11701@end deftypefn
11702
11703@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED (bool @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen})
11704Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
11705registers
11706that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
11707returns true, they will be included.  The target code must than make sure
11708that all target registers in the class returned by
11709@samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
11710saved.  @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
11711epilogues have already been generated.  Note, even if you only return
11712true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
11713to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
11714to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
11715@end deftypefn
11716
11717@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION (void)
11718This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
11719This target hook is required only when the target has several different
11720modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
11721@end deftypefn
11722
11723@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GEN_CCMP_FIRST (rtx_insn **@var{prep_seq}, rtx_insn **@var{gen_seq}, int @var{code}, tree @var{op0}, tree @var{op1})
11724This function prepares to emit a comparison insn for the first compare in a
11725 sequence of conditional comparisions.  It returns an appropriate comparison
11726 with @code{CC} for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}.
11727 The insns to prepare the compare are saved in @var{prep_seq} and the compare
11728 insns are saved in @var{gen_seq}.  They will be emitted when all the
11729 compares in the the conditional comparision are generated without error.
11730 @var{code} is the @code{rtx_code} of the compare for @var{op0} and @var{op1}.
11731@end deftypefn
11732
11733@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GEN_CCMP_NEXT (rtx_insn **@var{prep_seq}, rtx_insn **@var{gen_seq}, rtx @var{prev}, int @var{cmp_code}, tree @var{op0}, tree @var{op1}, int @var{bit_code})
11734This function prepares to emit a conditional comparison within a sequence
11735 of conditional comparisons.  It returns an appropriate comparison with
11736 @code{CC} for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}.
11737 The insns to prepare the compare are saved in @var{prep_seq} and the compare
11738 insns are saved in @var{gen_seq}.  They will be emitted when all the
11739 compares in the conditional comparision are generated without error.  The
11740 @var{prev} expression is the result of a prior call to @code{gen_ccmp_first}
11741 or @code{gen_ccmp_next}.  It may return @code{NULL} if the combination of
11742 @var{prev} and this comparison is not supported, otherwise the result must
11743 be appropriate for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}.
11744 @var{code} is the @code{rtx_code} of the compare for @var{op0} and @var{op1}.
11745 @var{bit_code} is @code{AND} or @code{IOR}, which is the op on the compares.
11746@end deftypefn
11747
11748@deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST (unsigned @var{nunroll}, struct loop *@var{loop})
11749This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
11750should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
11751the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
11752the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11753is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11754number of memory accesses.
11755@end deftypefn
11756
11757@defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
11758If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
11759that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11760that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11761constant inline.  When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11762more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11763system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11764The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11765@end defmac
11766
11767@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11768This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11769target.  The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
11770are present.  The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11771The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11772@end deftypefn
11773
11774@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11775This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11776target before any standard headers.  The parameter @var{stdinc}
11777indicates if normal include files are present.  The parameter
11778@var{sysroot} is the system root directory.  The parameter
11779@var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11780@end deftypefn
11781
11782@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11783This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11784The parameter @var{path} is the include to register.  On Darwin
11785systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11786that are different from @option{-I}.
11787@end deftypefn
11788
11789@defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11790This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
11791for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11792@code{false} otherwise.  By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11793functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11794@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11795@end defmac
11796
11797@defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11798If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11799target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11800option.  The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11801@end defmac
11802
11803@defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11804If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11805@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11806@end defmac
11807
11808@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11809If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11810target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11811default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11812@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11813@end defmac
11814
11815@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11816If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11817@code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11818@end defmac
11819
11820@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11821If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11822routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11823and scanf formatter settings.
11824@end defmac
11825
11826@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN (const_tree @var{typelist}, const_tree @var{funcdecl}, const_tree @var{val})
11827If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11828illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11829with prototype @var{typelist}.
11830@end deftypefn
11831
11832@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION (const_tree @var{fromtype}, const_tree @var{totype})
11833If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11834invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11835if validity should be determined by the front end.
11836@end deftypefn
11837
11838@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type})
11839If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11840invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11841@code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11842if validity should be determined by the front end.
11843@end deftypefn
11844
11845@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
11846If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11847invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11848and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11849the front end.
11850@end deftypefn
11851
11852@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11853If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11854@var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
11855analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11856front end's normal promotion rules.  This hook is useful when there are
11857target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11858This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11859@end deftypefn
11860
11861@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE (tree @var{type}, tree @var{expr})
11862If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11863@var{type}.  It should return the converted expression,
11864or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
11865This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
11866conversion rules.
11867This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11868@end deftypefn
11869
11870@defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11871This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11872NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11873@end defmac
11874
11875@defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11876Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
11877to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
11878call stack unwinding.  It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11879and the associated definitions of those functions.
11880@end defmac
11881
11882@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY (void)
11883Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11884necessary.
11885@end deftypefn
11886
11887@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX (void)
11888This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
11889different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
11890argument list due to stack realignment.  Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11891is needed.
11892@end deftypefn
11893
11894@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS (void)
11895When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11896arguments should be allocated to stack slots.  Normally, GCC allocates
11897stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11898debugging easier.  However, when a function is declared with
11899@code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11900cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11901to the stack.  Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11902false for naked functions.  The default implementation always returns true.
11903@end deftypefn
11904
11905@deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11906On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11907a constant.  If there is another constant already in a register that
11908is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11909is computed from this register using immediate addition or
11910subtraction.  We accomplish this through CSE.  Besides the value of
11911the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11912available expressions.  These are then queried when encountering new
11913constants.  The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11914down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11915@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11916accepted by immediate-add plus one.  We currently assume that the
11917value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2.  For example, on
11918MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11919@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}.  The default value
11920is zero, which disables this optimization.
11921@end deftypevr
11922
11923@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_ASAN_SHADOW_OFFSET (void)
11924Return the offset bitwise ored into shifted address to get corresponding
11925Address Sanitizer shadow memory address.  NULL if Address Sanitizer is not
11926supported by the target.
11927@end deftypefn
11928
11929@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_MEMMODEL_CHECK (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{val})
11930Validate target specific memory model mask bits. When NULL no target specific
11931memory model bits are allowed.
11932@end deftypefn
11933
11934@deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_ATOMIC_TEST_AND_SET_TRUEVAL
11935This value should be set if the result written by @code{atomic_test_and_set} is not exactly 1, i.e. the @code{bool} @code{true}.
11936@end deftypevr
11937
11938@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAS_IFUNC_P (void)
11939It returns true if the target supports GNU indirect functions.
11940The support includes the assembler, linker and dynamic linker.
11941The default value of this hook is based on target's libc.
11942@end deftypefn
11943
11944@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_ATOMIC_ALIGN_FOR_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode})
11945If defined, this function returns an appropriate alignment in bits for an atomic object of machine_mode @var{mode}.  If 0 is returned then the default alignment for the specified mode is used.
11946@end deftypefn
11947
11948@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ATOMIC_ASSIGN_EXPAND_FENV (tree *@var{hold}, tree *@var{clear}, tree *@var{update})
11949ISO C11 requires atomic compound assignments that may raise floating-point exceptions to raise exceptions corresponding to the arithmetic operation whose result was successfully stored in a compare-and-exchange sequence.  This requires code equivalent to calls to @code{feholdexcept}, @code{feclearexcept} and @code{feupdateenv} to be generated at appropriate points in the compare-and-exchange sequence.  This hook should set @code{*@var{hold}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feholdexcept}, @code{*@var{clear}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feclearexcept} and @code{*@var{update}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feupdateenv}.  The three expressions are @code{NULL_TREE} on entry to the hook and may be left as @code{NULL_TREE} if no code is required in a particular place.  The default implementation leaves all three expressions as @code{NULL_TREE}.  The @code{__atomic_feraiseexcept} function from @code{libatomic} may be of use as part of the code generated in @code{*@var{update}}.
11950@end deftypefn
11951
11952@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_RECORD_OFFLOAD_SYMBOL (tree)
11953Used when offloaded functions are seen in the compilation unit and no named
11954sections are available.  It is called once for each symbol that must be
11955recorded in the offload function and variable table.
11956@end deftypefn
11957
11958@deftypefn {Target Hook} {char *} TARGET_OFFLOAD_OPTIONS (void)
11959Used when writing out the list of options into an LTO file.  It should
11960translate any relevant target-specific options (such as the ABI in use)
11961into one of the @option{-foffload} options that exist as a common interface
11962to express such options.  It should return a string containing these options,
11963separated by spaces, which the caller will free.
11964
11965@end deftypefn
11966
11967@defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT
11968
11969On older ports, large integers are stored in @code{CONST_DOUBLE} rtl
11970objects.  Newer ports define @code{TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT} to be nonzero
11971to indicate that large integers are stored in
11972@code{CONST_WIDE_INT} rtl objects.  The @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} allows
11973very large integer constants to be represented.  @code{CONST_DOUBLE}
11974is limited to twice the size of the host's @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}
11975representation.
11976
11977Converting a port mostly requires looking for the places where
11978@code{CONST_DOUBLE}s are used with @code{VOIDmode} and replacing that
11979code with code that accesses @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}s.  @samp{"grep -i
11980const_double"} at the port level gets you to 95% of the changes that
11981need to be made.  There are a few places that require a deeper look.
11982
11983@itemize @bullet
11984@item
11985There is no equivalent to @code{hval} and @code{lval} for
11986@code{CONST_WIDE_INT}s.  This would be difficult to express in the md
11987language since there are a variable number of elements.
11988
11989Most ports only check that @code{hval} is either 0 or -1 to see if the
11990value is small.  As mentioned above, this will no longer be necessary
11991since small constants are always @code{CONST_INT}.  Of course there
11992are still a few exceptions, the alpha's constraint used by the zap
11993instruction certainly requires careful examination by C code.
11994However, all the current code does is pass the hval and lval to C
11995code, so evolving the c code to look at the @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} is
11996not really a large change.
11997
11998@item
11999Because there is no standard template that ports use to materialize
12000constants, there is likely to be some futzing that is unique to each
12001port in this code.
12002
12003@item
12004The rtx costs may have to be adjusted to properly account for larger
12005constants that are represented as @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}.
12006@end itemize
12007
12008All and all it does not take long to convert ports that the
12009maintainer is familiar with.
12010
12011@end defmac
12012
12013@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_RUN_TARGET_SELFTESTS (void)
12014If selftests are enabled, run any selftests for this target.
12015@end deftypefn
12016